2004-02-22 Andrew Cagney <cagney@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
18
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
23
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
27
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
29
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
37
38 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
39 #include "coff/sym.h"
40 #include "coff/symconst.h"
41 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
42 #include "coff/mips.h"
43
44 #include "hashtab.h"
45
46 /* This structure is used to hold .got entries while estimating got
47 sizes. */
48 struct mips_got_entry
49 {
50 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
51 bfd *abfd;
52 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
53 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
54 long symndx;
55 union
56 {
57 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
58 bfd_vma address;
59 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
60 that should be added to the symbol value. */
61 bfd_vma addend;
62 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
63 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
64 h->forced_local). */
65 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
66 } d;
67 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
68 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
69 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
70 long gotidx;
71 };
72
73 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
74
75 struct mips_got_info
76 {
77 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
78 symbol table. */
79 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
80 /* The number of global .got entries. */
81 unsigned int global_gotno;
82 /* The number of local .got entries. */
83 unsigned int local_gotno;
84 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
85 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
86 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
87 struct htab *got_entries;
88 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
89 unless multi-got was necessary. */
90 struct htab *bfd2got;
91 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
92 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
93 struct mips_got_info *next;
94 };
95
96 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
97
98 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
99 bfd *bfd;
100 struct mips_got_info *g;
101 };
102
103 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
104 create and merge bfd's gots. */
105
106 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
107 {
108 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
109 htab_t bfd2got;
110 /* The output bfd. */
111 bfd *obfd;
112 /* The link information. */
113 struct bfd_link_info *info;
114 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
115 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
116 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
117 struct mips_got_info *primary;
118 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
119 gots. */
120 struct mips_got_info *current;
121 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
122 16-bit offset. */
123 unsigned int max_count;
124 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
125 unsigned int primary_count;
126 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
127 unsigned int current_count;
128 };
129
130 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
131
132 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
133 {
134 struct mips_got_info *g;
135 int value;
136 unsigned int needed_relocs;
137 struct bfd_link_info *info;
138 };
139
140 struct _mips_elf_section_data
141 {
142 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
143 union
144 {
145 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
146 bfd_byte *tdata;
147 } u;
148 };
149
150 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
151 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
152
153 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
154 the dynamic symbols. */
155
156 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
157 {
158 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
159 index. */
160 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
161 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
162 with a GOT entry. */
163 long min_got_dynindx;
164 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
165 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
166 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
167 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
168 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
169 symbol without a GOT entry. */
170 long max_non_got_dynindx;
171 };
172
173 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
174 the global hash table. */
175
176 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
177 {
178 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
179
180 /* External symbol information. */
181 EXTR esym;
182
183 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
184 this symbol. */
185 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
186
187 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
188 a readonly section. */
189 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
190
191 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
192 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
193 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
194 p. 4-20. */
195 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
196
197 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
198 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
199 asection *fn_stub;
200
201 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
202 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
203 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
204
205 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
206 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
207 asection *call_stub;
208
209 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
210 being called returns a floating point value. */
211 asection *call_fp_stub;
212
213 /* Are we forced local? .*/
214 bfd_boolean forced_local;
215 };
216
217 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
218
219 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
220 {
221 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
222 #if 0
223 /* We no longer use this. */
224 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
225 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
226 #endif
227 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
228 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
229 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
230 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
231 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
232 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
233 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
234 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
235 bfd_vma rld_value;
236 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
237 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
238 };
239
240 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
241
242 struct extsym_info
243 {
244 bfd *abfd;
245 struct bfd_link_info *info;
246 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
247 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
248 bfd_boolean failed;
249 };
250
251 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
252
253 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
254 {
255 "_procedure_table",
256 "_procedure_string_table",
257 "_procedure_table_size",
258 NULL
259 };
260
261 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
262 IRIX5. */
263
264 typedef struct
265 {
266 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
267 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
268 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
269 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
270 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
271 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
272 } Elf32_compact_rel;
273
274 typedef struct
275 {
276 bfd_byte id1[4];
277 bfd_byte num[4];
278 bfd_byte id2[4];
279 bfd_byte offset[4];
280 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
281 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
282 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
283
284 typedef struct
285 {
286 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
287 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
288 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
289 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
290 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
291 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
292 } Elf32_crinfo;
293
294 typedef struct
295 {
296 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
297 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
298 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
299 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
300 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
301 } Elf32_crinfo2;
302
303 typedef struct
304 {
305 bfd_byte info[4];
306 bfd_byte konst[4];
307 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
308 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
309
310 typedef struct
311 {
312 bfd_byte info[4];
313 bfd_byte konst[4];
314 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
315
316 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
317
318 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
319 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
320 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
321 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
322 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
323 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
324 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
325 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
326
327 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
328 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
329 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
330 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
331 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
332
333 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
334 has different meaning for each type:
335
336 (type) (konst)
337 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
338 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
339 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
340 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
341 */
342
343 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
344 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
345 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
346 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
347
348 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
349 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
350 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
351 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
352 \f
353 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
354 loader for use by the static exception system. */
355
356 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
357 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
358 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
359 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
360 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
361 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
362 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
363 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
364 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
365 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
366 long reserved;
367 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
368 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
369 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
370 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
371 \f
372 static struct bfd_hash_entry *mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc
373 (struct bfd_hash_entry *, struct bfd_hash_table *, const char *);
374 static void ecoff_swap_rpdr_out
375 (bfd *, const RPDR *, struct rpdr_ext *);
376 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_procedure_table
377 (void *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *,
378 struct ecoff_debug_info *);
379 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs
380 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
381 static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in
382 (bfd *, const Elf32_External_gptab *, Elf32_gptab *);
383 static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out
384 (bfd *, const Elf32_gptab *, Elf32_External_gptab *);
385 static void bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out
386 (bfd *, const Elf32_compact_rel *, Elf32_External_compact_rel *);
387 static void bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out
388 (bfd *, const Elf32_crinfo *, Elf32_External_crinfo *);
389 static int sort_dynamic_relocs
390 (const void *, const void *);
391 static int sort_dynamic_relocs_64
392 (const void *, const void *);
393 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_output_extsym
394 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
395 static int gptab_compare
396 (const void *, const void *);
397 static asection *mips_elf_rel_dyn_section
398 (bfd *, bfd_boolean);
399 static asection *mips_elf_got_section
400 (bfd *, bfd_boolean);
401 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_info
402 (bfd *, asection **);
403 static long mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index
404 (bfd *abfd);
405 static bfd_vma mips_elf_local_got_index
406 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma);
407 static bfd_vma mips_elf_global_got_index
408 (bfd *, bfd *, struct elf_link_hash_entry *);
409 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_page
410 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma *);
411 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got16_entry
412 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_boolean);
413 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_offset_from_index
414 (bfd *, bfd *, bfd *, bfd_vma);
415 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
416 (bfd *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *, bfd_vma);
417 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table
418 (struct bfd_link_info *, unsigned long);
419 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
420 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
421 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol
422 (bfd *, long, bfd_vma, struct mips_got_info *);
423 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol
424 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *,
425 struct mips_got_info *);
426 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *mips_elf_next_relocation
427 (bfd *, unsigned int, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *);
428 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_local_relocation_p
429 (bfd *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, asection **, bfd_boolean);
430 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_overflow_p
431 (bfd_vma, int);
432 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
433 (bfd_vma);
434 static bfd_vma mips_elf_higher
435 (bfd_vma);
436 static bfd_vma mips_elf_highest
437 (bfd_vma);
438 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
439 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
440 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_got_section
441 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_boolean);
442 static bfd_reloc_status_type mips_elf_calculate_relocation
443 (bfd *, bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *,
444 const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma, reloc_howto_type *,
445 Elf_Internal_Sym *, asection **, bfd_vma *, const char **,
446 bfd_boolean *, bfd_boolean);
447 static bfd_vma mips_elf_obtain_contents
448 (reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, bfd_byte *);
449 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_perform_relocation
450 (struct bfd_link_info *, reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
451 bfd_vma, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_boolean);
452 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_stub_section_p
453 (bfd *, asection *);
454 static void mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
455 (bfd *, unsigned int);
456 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
457 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
458 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
459 bfd_vma *, asection *);
460 static void mips_set_isa_flags
461 (bfd *);
462 static INLINE char *elf_mips_abi_name
463 (bfd *);
464 static void mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol
465 (bfd *, const char *, Elf_Internal_Sym *);
466 static bfd_boolean mips_mach_extends_p
467 (unsigned long, unsigned long);
468 static bfd_boolean mips_32bit_flags_p
469 (flagword);
470 static INLINE hashval_t mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma
471 (bfd_vma);
472 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
473 (const void *);
474 static int mips_elf_got_entry_eq
475 (const void *, const void *);
476
477 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_multi_got
478 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, struct mips_got_info *,
479 asection *, bfd_size_type);
480 static hashval_t mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash
481 (const void *);
482 static int mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq
483 (const void *, const void *);
484 static hashval_t mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash
485 (const void *);
486 static int mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq
487 (const void *, const void *);
488 static int mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd
489 (void **, void *);
490 static int mips_elf_merge_gots
491 (void **, void *);
492 static int mips_elf_set_global_got_offset
493 (void **, void *);
494 static int mips_elf_set_no_stub
495 (void **, void *);
496 static int mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry
497 (void **, void *);
498 static void mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries
499 (struct mips_got_info *);
500 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
501 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
502 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
503 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
504
505 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
506 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
507
508 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
509
510 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
511 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
512
513 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
514 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
515 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
516
517 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
518 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
519
520 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
521 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
522 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
523
524 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
525 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
526 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
527
528 /* The name of the options section. */
529 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
530 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
531
532 /* The name of the stub section. */
533 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
534 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.stubs" : ".stub")
535
536 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
537 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
538 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
539
540 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
541 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
542 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
543
544 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
545 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
546 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
547
548 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
549 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
550 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
551
552 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
553 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
554 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
555
556 /* Get word-sized data. */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
558 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
559
560 /* Put out word-sized data. */
561 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
562 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
563 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
564 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
565
566 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
567 #ifdef BFD64
568 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
569 (ABI_64_P (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj) \
570 ? bfd_elf64_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val) \
571 : bfd_elf32_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val))
572 #else
573 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
574 (ABI_64_P (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj) \
575 ? (abort (), FALSE) \
576 : bfd_elf32_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val))
577 #endif
578
579 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
580 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
581
582 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
583 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
584 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
585 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
586 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
587 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
588 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
589 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
590 section, that is RELA. */
591 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
592 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
593 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
594 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
595 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
596 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
597 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
598
599 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
600 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
601 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
602
603 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
604 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (2)
605
606 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
607 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) (0x7ff0)
608
609 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
610 offsets from $gp. */
611 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(abfd) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) + 0x7fff)
612
613 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
614 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
615 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
616 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
617 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
618 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
619 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
620 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
621 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
622 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
623 #define STUB_LI16(abfd) \
624 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
625 ? 0x64180000 /* daddiu t8,zero,0 */ \
626 : 0x24180000)) /* addiu t8,zero,0 */
627 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE (16)
628
629 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
630 section. */
631
632 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
633 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
634 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
635 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
636
637 #ifdef BFD64
638 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
639 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
640 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
641 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
642 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
643 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
644 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
645 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
646 #else
647 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
648 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
649 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
650 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
651 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
652 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
653 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
654 #endif
655 \f
656 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
657 floating point arguments.
658
659 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
660 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
661 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
662 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
663 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
664 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
665 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
666 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
667
668 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
669 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
670 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
671 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
672 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
673 stub should be discarded.
674
675 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
676 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
677 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
678 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
679 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
680 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
681 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
682 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
683
684 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
685 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
686 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
687
688 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
689
690 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
691 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
692 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
693 \f
694 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
695
696 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
697 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
698 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
699 (copy), (follow)))
700
701 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
702
703 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
704 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
705 (&(table)->root, \
706 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
707 (info)))
708
709 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
710
711 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
712 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
713
714 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
715
716 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
717 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
718 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
719 {
720 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
721 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
722
723 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
724 subclass. */
725 if (ret == NULL)
726 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
727 if (ret == NULL)
728 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
729
730 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
731 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
732 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
733 table, string));
734 if (ret != NULL)
735 {
736 /* Set local fields. */
737 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
738 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
739 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
740 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
741 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
742 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
743 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
744 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
745 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
746 ret->call_stub = NULL;
747 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
748 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
749 }
750
751 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
752 }
753
754 bfd_boolean
755 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
756 {
757 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
758 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
759
760 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
761 if (sdata == NULL)
762 return FALSE;
763 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
764
765 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
766 }
767 \f
768 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
769 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
770
771 bfd_boolean
772 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
773 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
774 {
775 HDRR *symhdr;
776 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
777 char *ext_hdr;
778
779 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
780 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
781
782 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
783 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
784 goto error_return;
785
786 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
787 swap->external_hdr_size))
788 goto error_return;
789
790 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
791 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
792
793 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
794 read. */
795 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
796 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
797 debug->ptr = NULL; \
798 else \
799 { \
800 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
801 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
802 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
803 goto error_return; \
804 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
805 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
806 goto error_return; \
807 }
808
809 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
810 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
811 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
812 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
813 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
814 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
815 union aux_ext *);
816 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
817 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
818 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
819 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
820 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
821 #undef READ
822
823 debug->fdr = NULL;
824 debug->adjust = NULL;
825
826 return TRUE;
827
828 error_return:
829 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
830 free (ext_hdr);
831 if (debug->line != NULL)
832 free (debug->line);
833 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
834 free (debug->external_dnr);
835 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
836 free (debug->external_pdr);
837 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
838 free (debug->external_sym);
839 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
840 free (debug->external_opt);
841 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
842 free (debug->external_aux);
843 if (debug->ss != NULL)
844 free (debug->ss);
845 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
846 free (debug->ssext);
847 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
848 free (debug->external_fdr);
849 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
850 free (debug->external_rfd);
851 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
852 free (debug->external_ext);
853 return FALSE;
854 }
855 \f
856 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
857
858 static void
859 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
860 {
861 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
862 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
863 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
864 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
865 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
866 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
867
868 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
869 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
870
871 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
872 #if 0 /* FIXME */
873 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->exception_info, ex->p_exception_info);
874 #endif
875 }
876
877 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
878
879 static bfd_boolean
880 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
881 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
882 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
883 {
884 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
885 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
886 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
887 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
888 void *rtproc;
889 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
890 struct sym_ext *esym;
891 char *ss, **sv;
892 char *str;
893 bfd_size_type size;
894 bfd_size_type count;
895 unsigned long sindex;
896 unsigned long i;
897 PDR pdr;
898 SYMR sym;
899 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
900
901 epdr = NULL;
902 rpdr = NULL;
903 esym = NULL;
904 ss = NULL;
905 sv = NULL;
906
907 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
908
909 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
910 count = hdr->ipdMax;
911 if (count > 0)
912 {
913 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
914
915 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
916 if (epdr == NULL)
917 goto error_return;
918
919 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
920 goto error_return;
921
922 size = sizeof (RPDR);
923 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
924 if (rpdr == NULL)
925 goto error_return;
926
927 size = sizeof (char *);
928 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
929 if (sv == NULL)
930 goto error_return;
931
932 count = hdr->isymMax;
933 size = swap->external_sym_size;
934 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
935 if (esym == NULL)
936 goto error_return;
937
938 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
939 goto error_return;
940
941 count = hdr->issMax;
942 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
943 if (ss == NULL)
944 goto error_return;
945 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, ss))
946 goto error_return;
947
948 count = hdr->ipdMax;
949 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
950 {
951 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
952 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
953 rp->adr = sym.value;
954 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
955 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
956 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
957 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
958 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
959 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
960 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
961 rp->irpss = sindex;
962 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
963 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
964 }
965 }
966
967 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
968 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
969 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
970 if (rtproc == NULL)
971 {
972 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
973 goto error_return;
974 }
975
976 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
977
978 erp = rtproc;
979 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
980 erp++;
981 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
982 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
983 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
984 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
985 {
986 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
987 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
988 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
989 }
990 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
991
992 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
993 s->_raw_size = size;
994 s->contents = rtproc;
995
996 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
997 matters, but someday it might). */
998 s->link_order_head = NULL;
999
1000 if (epdr != NULL)
1001 free (epdr);
1002 if (rpdr != NULL)
1003 free (rpdr);
1004 if (esym != NULL)
1005 free (esym);
1006 if (ss != NULL)
1007 free (ss);
1008 if (sv != NULL)
1009 free (sv);
1010
1011 return TRUE;
1012
1013 error_return:
1014 if (epdr != NULL)
1015 free (epdr);
1016 if (rpdr != NULL)
1017 free (rpdr);
1018 if (esym != NULL)
1019 free (esym);
1020 if (ss != NULL)
1021 free (ss);
1022 if (sv != NULL)
1023 free (sv);
1024 return FALSE;
1025 }
1026
1027 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1028 discard them. */
1029
1030 static bfd_boolean
1031 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1032 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1033 {
1034 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1035 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1036
1037 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1038 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1039 {
1040 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1041 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1042 being included in the link. */
1043 h->fn_stub->_raw_size = 0;
1044 h->fn_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
1045 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1046 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1047 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1048 }
1049
1050 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1051 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1052 {
1053 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1054 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1055 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1056 h->call_stub->_raw_size = 0;
1057 h->call_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
1058 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1059 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1060 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1061 }
1062
1063 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1064 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1065 {
1066 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1067 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1068 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1069 h->call_fp_stub->_raw_size = 0;
1070 h->call_fp_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
1071 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1072 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1073 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1074 }
1075
1076 return TRUE;
1077 }
1078 \f
1079 bfd_reloc_status_type
1080 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1081 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1082 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1083 {
1084 bfd_vma relocation;
1085 bfd_signed_vma val;
1086 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1087
1088 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1089 relocation = 0;
1090 else
1091 relocation = symbol->value;
1092
1093 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1094 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1095
1096 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
1097 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1098
1099 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1100 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1101
1102 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1103
1104 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1105 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1106 an external symbol. */
1107 if (! relocatable
1108 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1109 val += relocation - gp;
1110
1111 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1112 {
1113 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1114 (bfd_byte *) data
1115 + reloc_entry->address);
1116 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1117 return status;
1118 }
1119 else
1120 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1121
1122 if (relocatable)
1123 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1124
1125 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1126 }
1127
1128 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1129 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1130 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1131 INPUT_SECTION. */
1132
1133 struct mips_hi16
1134 {
1135 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1136 bfd_byte *data;
1137 asection *input_section;
1138 arelent rel;
1139 };
1140
1141 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1142
1143 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1144
1145 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1146 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1147 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1148
1149 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1150 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1151 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1152 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1153
1154 bfd_reloc_status_type
1155 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1156 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1157 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1158 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1159 {
1160 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1161
1162 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
1163 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1164
1165 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1166 if (n == NULL)
1167 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1168
1169 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1170 n->data = data;
1171 n->input_section = input_section;
1172 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1173 mips_hi16_list = n;
1174
1175 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1176 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1177
1178 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1179 }
1180
1181 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1182 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1183 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1184
1185 bfd_reloc_status_type
1186 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1187 void *data, asection *input_section,
1188 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1189 {
1190 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1191 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1192 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1193 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1194 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1195 input_section, output_bfd,
1196 error_message);
1197
1198 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1199 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1200 }
1201
1202 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1203 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1204 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1205
1206 bfd_reloc_status_type
1207 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1208 void *data, asection *input_section,
1209 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1210 {
1211 bfd_vma vallo;
1212
1213 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
1214 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1215
1216 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1217 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1218 {
1219 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1220 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1221
1222 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1223
1224 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1225 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1226 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1227 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1228 has a rightshift of 0. */
1229 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1230 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1231
1232 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1233 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1234 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1235
1236 /* R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16 relocations are relative to the address of the
1237 lo16 relocation, not their own address. If we're calculating the
1238 final value, and hence subtracting the "PC", subtract the offset
1239 of the lo16 relocation from here. */
1240 if (output_bfd == NULL && hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
1241 hi->rel.addend -= reloc_entry->address - hi->rel.address;
1242
1243 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1244 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1245 error_message);
1246 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1247 return ret;
1248
1249 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1250 free (hi);
1251 }
1252
1253 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1254 input_section, output_bfd,
1255 error_message);
1256 }
1257
1258 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1259 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1260 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1261
1262 bfd_reloc_status_type
1263 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1264 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1265 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1266 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1267 {
1268 bfd_signed_vma val;
1269 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1270 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1271
1272 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1273
1274 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
1275 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1276
1277 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1278 val = 0;
1279 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1280 {
1281 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1282 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1283 offset or address. */
1284 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1285 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1286 }
1287
1288 if (!relocatable)
1289 {
1290 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1291 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1292 val += symbol->value;
1293 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1294 {
1295 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1296 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1297 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1298 }
1299 }
1300
1301 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1302 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1303 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1304 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1305 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1306 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1307 else
1308 {
1309 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1310 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1311
1312 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1313 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1314 (bfd_byte *) data
1315 + reloc_entry->address);
1316 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1317 return status;
1318 }
1319
1320 if (relocatable)
1321 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1322
1323 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1324 }
1325 \f
1326 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1327 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1328
1329 static void
1330 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1331 Elf32_gptab *in)
1332 {
1333 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1334 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1335 }
1336
1337 static void
1338 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1339 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1340 {
1341 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1342 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1343 }
1344
1345 static void
1346 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1347 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1348 {
1349 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1350 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1351 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1352 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1353 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1354 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1355 }
1356
1357 static void
1358 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1359 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1360 {
1361 unsigned long l;
1362
1363 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1364 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1365 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1366 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1367 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1368 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1369 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1370 }
1371 \f
1372 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1373 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1374 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1375
1376 void
1377 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1378 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1379 {
1380 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1381 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1382 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1383 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1384 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1385 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1386 }
1387
1388 void
1389 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1390 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1391 {
1392 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1393 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1394 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1395 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1396 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1397 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1398 }
1399
1400 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1401 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1402 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1403 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1404 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1405
1406 void
1407 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1408 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1409 {
1410 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1411 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1412 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1413 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1414 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1415 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1416 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1417 }
1418
1419 void
1420 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1421 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1422 {
1423 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1424 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1425 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1426 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1427 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1428 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1429 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1430 }
1431
1432 /* Swap in an options header. */
1433
1434 void
1435 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1436 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1437 {
1438 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1439 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1440 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1441 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1442 }
1443
1444 /* Swap out an options header. */
1445
1446 void
1447 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1448 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1449 {
1450 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1451 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1452 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1453 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1454 }
1455 \f
1456 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1457 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1458
1459 static int
1460 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1461 {
1462 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1463 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1464
1465 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1466 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1467
1468 return ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1469 }
1470
1471 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1472
1473 static int
1474 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1475 {
1476 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1477 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1478
1479 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1480 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1481 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1482 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1483
1484 return (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info)
1485 - ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info));
1486 }
1487
1488
1489 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1490 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1491 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1492 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1493 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1494 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1495 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1496 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1497 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1498 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1499 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1500 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1501 when generating a final executable. */
1502
1503 static bfd_boolean
1504 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1505 {
1506 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1507 bfd_boolean strip;
1508 asection *sec, *output_section;
1509
1510 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1511 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1512
1513 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1514 strip = FALSE;
1515 else if (((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0
1516 || (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
1517 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0
1518 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) == 0)
1519 strip = TRUE;
1520 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1521 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1522 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1523 h->root.root.root.string,
1524 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1525 strip = TRUE;
1526 else
1527 strip = FALSE;
1528
1529 if (strip)
1530 return TRUE;
1531
1532 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1533 {
1534 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1535 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1536 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1537 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1538 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1539 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1540 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1541
1542 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1543 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1544 {
1545 const char *name;
1546
1547 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1548 special symbols. */
1549 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1550 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1551 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1552 {
1553 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1554 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1555 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1556 }
1557 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1558 {
1559 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1560 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1561 h->esym.asym.value =
1562 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1563 }
1564 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1565 {
1566 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1567 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1568 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1569 }
1570 else
1571 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1572 }
1573 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1574 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1575 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1576 else
1577 {
1578 const char *name;
1579
1580 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1581 output_section = sec->output_section;
1582
1583 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1584 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1585 if (output_section == NULL)
1586 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1587 else
1588 {
1589 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1590
1591 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1592 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1593 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1594 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1595 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1596 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1597 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1598 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1599 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1600 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1601 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1602 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1603 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1604 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1605 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1606 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1607 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1608 else
1609 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1614 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1615 }
1616
1617 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1618 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1619 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1620 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1621 {
1622 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1623 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1624 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1625 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1626
1627 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1628 output_section = sec->output_section;
1629 if (output_section != NULL)
1630 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1631 + sec->output_offset
1632 + output_section->vma);
1633 else
1634 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1635 }
1636 else if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0)
1637 {
1638 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1639 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1640
1641 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1642 {
1643 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1644 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1645 }
1646
1647 if (!no_fn_stub)
1648 {
1649 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1650 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1651 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1652 if (sec == NULL)
1653 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1654 else
1655 {
1656 output_section = sec->output_section;
1657 if (output_section != NULL)
1658 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1659 + sec->output_offset
1660 + output_section->vma);
1661 else
1662 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1663 }
1664 #if 0 /* FIXME? */
1665 h->esym.ifd = 0;
1666 #endif
1667 }
1668 }
1669
1670 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1671 h->root.root.root.string,
1672 &h->esym))
1673 {
1674 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1675 return FALSE;
1676 }
1677
1678 return TRUE;
1679 }
1680
1681 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1682
1683 static int
1684 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1685 {
1686 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1687 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1688
1689 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1690 }
1691 \f
1692 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1693
1694 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1695 hash number. */
1696
1697 static INLINE hashval_t
1698 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1699 {
1700 #ifdef BFD64
1701 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1702 #else
1703 return addr;
1704 #endif
1705 }
1706
1707 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1708 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1709 union members. */
1710
1711 static hashval_t
1712 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1713 {
1714 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1715
1716 return entry->symndx
1717 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1718 : entry->abfd->id
1719 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1720 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1721 }
1722
1723 static int
1724 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1725 {
1726 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1727 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1728
1729 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1730 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1731 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1732 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1733 }
1734
1735 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
1736 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
1737 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
1738 accordingly. */
1739
1740 static hashval_t
1741 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1742 {
1743 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1744
1745 return entry->symndx
1746 + (! entry->abfd
1747 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1748 : entry->symndx >= 0
1749 ? (entry->abfd->id
1750 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend))
1751 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
1752 }
1753
1754 static int
1755 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1756 {
1757 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1758 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1759
1760 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1761 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1762 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
1763 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1764 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 /* Returns the dynamic relocation section for DYNOBJ. */
1768
1769 static asection *
1770 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (bfd *dynobj, bfd_boolean create_p)
1771 {
1772 static const char dname[] = ".rel.dyn";
1773 asection *sreloc;
1774
1775 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
1776 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
1777 {
1778 sreloc = bfd_make_section (dynobj, dname);
1779 if (sreloc == NULL
1780 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, sreloc,
1781 (SEC_ALLOC
1782 | SEC_LOAD
1783 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
1784 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1785 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
1786 | SEC_READONLY))
1787 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
1788 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
1789 return NULL;
1790 }
1791 return sreloc;
1792 }
1793
1794 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
1795
1796 static asection *
1797 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
1798 {
1799 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1800 if (sgot == NULL
1801 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
1802 return NULL;
1803 return sgot;
1804 }
1805
1806 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
1807 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
1808 section. */
1809
1810 static struct mips_got_info *
1811 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
1812 {
1813 asection *sgot;
1814 struct mips_got_info *g;
1815
1816 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
1817 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
1818 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
1819 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
1820 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
1821
1822 if (sgotp)
1823 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
1824
1825 return g;
1826 }
1827
1828 /* Obtain the lowest dynamic index of a symbol that was assigned a
1829 global GOT entry. */
1830 static long
1831 mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index (bfd *abfd)
1832 {
1833 asection *sgot;
1834 struct mips_got_info *g;
1835
1836 if (abfd == NULL)
1837 return 0;
1838
1839 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
1840 if (sgot == NULL || mips_elf_section_data (sgot) == NULL)
1841 return 0;
1842
1843 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
1844 if (g == NULL || g->global_gotsym == NULL)
1845 return 0;
1846
1847 return g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
1848 }
1849
1850 /* Returns the GOT offset at which the indicated address can be found.
1851 If there is not yet a GOT entry for this value, create one. Returns
1852 -1 if no satisfactory GOT offset can be found. */
1853
1854 static bfd_vma
1855 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
1856 bfd_vma value)
1857 {
1858 asection *sgot;
1859 struct mips_got_info *g;
1860 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
1861
1862 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
1863
1864 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value);
1865 if (entry)
1866 return entry->gotidx;
1867 else
1868 return MINUS_ONE;
1869 }
1870
1871 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
1872
1873 static bfd_vma
1874 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1875 {
1876 bfd_vma index;
1877 asection *sgot;
1878 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
1879 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
1880
1881 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
1882 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
1883 {
1884 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
1885
1886 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
1887
1888 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
1889 if (g->next != gg)
1890 {
1891 e.abfd = ibfd;
1892 e.symndx = -1;
1893 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
1894
1895 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
1896
1897 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
1898 return p->gotidx;
1899 }
1900 }
1901
1902 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
1903 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
1904
1905 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
1906 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
1907 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
1908 offset. */
1909 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
1910 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
1911 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
1912 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->_raw_size);
1913
1914 return index;
1915 }
1916
1917 /* Find a GOT entry that is within 32KB of the VALUE. These entries
1918 are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
1919 within 32KB of GP. Return the index into the GOT for this page,
1920 and store the offset from this entry to the desired address in
1921 OFFSETP, if it is non-NULL. */
1922
1923 static bfd_vma
1924 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
1925 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
1926 {
1927 asection *sgot;
1928 struct mips_got_info *g;
1929 bfd_vma index;
1930 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
1931
1932 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
1933
1934 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot,
1935 (value + 0x8000)
1936 & (~(bfd_vma)0xffff));
1937
1938 if (!entry)
1939 return MINUS_ONE;
1940
1941 index = entry->gotidx;
1942
1943 if (offsetp)
1944 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
1945
1946 return index;
1947 }
1948
1949 /* Find a GOT entry whose higher-order 16 bits are the same as those
1950 for value. Return the index into the GOT for this entry. */
1951
1952 static bfd_vma
1953 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
1954 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
1955 {
1956 asection *sgot;
1957 struct mips_got_info *g;
1958 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
1959
1960 if (! external)
1961 {
1962 /* Although the ABI says that it is "the high-order 16 bits" that we
1963 want, it is really the %high value. The complete value is
1964 calculated with a `addiu' of a LO16 relocation, just as with a
1965 HI16/LO16 pair. */
1966 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
1967 }
1968
1969 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
1970
1971 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value);
1972 if (entry)
1973 return entry->gotidx;
1974 else
1975 return MINUS_ONE;
1976 }
1977
1978 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
1979 in the GOT. */
1980
1981 static bfd_vma
1982 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
1983 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
1984 {
1985 asection *sgot;
1986 bfd_vma gp;
1987 struct mips_got_info *g;
1988
1989 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
1990 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
1991 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
1992
1993 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
1994 }
1995
1996 /* Create a local GOT entry for VALUE. Return the index of the entry,
1997 or -1 if it could not be created. */
1998
1999 static struct mips_got_entry *
2000 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd,
2001 struct mips_got_info *gg,
2002 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value)
2003 {
2004 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2005 struct mips_got_info *g;
2006
2007 entry.abfd = NULL;
2008 entry.symndx = -1;
2009 entry.d.address = value;
2010
2011 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2012 if (g == NULL)
2013 {
2014 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2015 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2016 }
2017
2018 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2019 INSERT);
2020 if (*loc)
2021 return *loc;
2022
2023 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2024
2025 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2026
2027 if (! *loc)
2028 return NULL;
2029
2030 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2031
2032 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2033 {
2034 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2035 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2036 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2037 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2038 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2039 return NULL;
2040 }
2041
2042 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2043 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2044
2045 return *loc;
2046 }
2047
2048 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2049 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2050 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2051 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2052 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2053 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2054
2055 static bfd_boolean
2056 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2057 {
2058 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2059 struct mips_got_info *g;
2060 bfd *dynobj;
2061
2062 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2063
2064 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2065
2066 hsd.low = NULL;
2067 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2068 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2069 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2070 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2071 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2072 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2073 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2074 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2075 too large offsets. */
2076 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2077 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2078 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2079 elf_hash_table (info)),
2080 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2081 &hsd);
2082
2083 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2084 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2085 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2086 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2087 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2088
2089 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2090 table index in the GOT. */
2091 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2092
2093 return TRUE;
2094 }
2095
2096 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2097 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2098 index. */
2099
2100 static bfd_boolean
2101 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2102 {
2103 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2104
2105 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2106 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2107
2108 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2109 at all. */
2110 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2111 return TRUE;
2112
2113 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2114 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2115 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2116 -1. */
2117 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2118 {
2119 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2120 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2121 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2122 }
2123 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2124 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2125 else
2126 {
2127 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2128 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2129 }
2130
2131 return TRUE;
2132 }
2133
2134 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2135 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2136 posterity. */
2137
2138 static bfd_boolean
2139 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2140 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2141 struct mips_got_info *g)
2142 {
2143 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2144
2145 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2146 table. */
2147 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2148 {
2149 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2150 {
2151 case STV_INTERNAL:
2152 case STV_HIDDEN:
2153 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2154 break;
2155 }
2156 if (!bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2157 return FALSE;
2158 }
2159
2160 entry.abfd = abfd;
2161 entry.symndx = -1;
2162 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2163
2164 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2165 INSERT);
2166
2167 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2168 need to do it again. */
2169 if (*loc)
2170 return TRUE;
2171
2172 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2173
2174 if (! *loc)
2175 return FALSE;
2176
2177 entry.gotidx = -1;
2178 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2179
2180 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2181 return TRUE;
2182
2183 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2184 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2185 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2186 h->got.offset = 1;
2187
2188 return TRUE;
2189 }
2190
2191 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2192 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2193
2194 static bfd_boolean
2195 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2196 struct mips_got_info *g)
2197 {
2198 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2199
2200 entry.abfd = abfd;
2201 entry.symndx = symndx;
2202 entry.d.addend = addend;
2203 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2204 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2205
2206 if (*loc)
2207 return TRUE;
2208
2209 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2210
2211 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2212
2213 if (! *loc)
2214 return FALSE;
2215
2216 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2217
2218 return TRUE;
2219 }
2220 \f
2221 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
2222
2223 static hashval_t
2224 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2225 {
2226 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2227 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2228
2229 return entry->bfd->id;
2230 }
2231
2232 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
2233
2234 static int
2235 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2236 {
2237 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2238 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2239 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2240 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2241
2242 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2243 }
2244
2245 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBDF. G must
2246 be the master GOT data. */
2247
2248 static struct mips_got_info *
2249 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2250 {
2251 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2252
2253 if (! g->bfd2got)
2254 return g;
2255
2256 e.bfd = ibfd;
2257 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2258 return p ? p->g : NULL;
2259 }
2260
2261 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2262 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2263 bfd requires. */
2264
2265 static int
2266 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2267 {
2268 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2269 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2270 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
2271 struct mips_got_info *g;
2272 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
2273 void **bfdgotp;
2274
2275 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
2276 none exists. */
2277 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
2278 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
2279 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
2280
2281 if (bfdgot != NULL)
2282 g = bfdgot->g;
2283 else
2284 {
2285 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
2286 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
2287
2288 if (bfdgot == NULL)
2289 {
2290 arg->obfd = 0;
2291 return 0;
2292 }
2293
2294 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
2295
2296 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
2297 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
2298 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
2299 if (g == NULL)
2300 {
2301 arg->obfd = 0;
2302 return 0;
2303 }
2304
2305 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
2306 g->global_gotno = 0;
2307 g->local_gotno = 0;
2308 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
2309 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
2310 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
2311 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
2312 {
2313 arg->obfd = 0;
2314 return 0;
2315 }
2316
2317 g->bfd2got = NULL;
2318 g->next = NULL;
2319 }
2320
2321 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
2322 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
2323 if (*entryp != NULL)
2324 return 1;
2325
2326 *entryp = entry;
2327
2328 if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
2329 ++g->local_gotno;
2330 else
2331 ++g->global_gotno;
2332
2333 return 1;
2334 }
2335
2336 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
2337 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
2338 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
2339 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
2340 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
2341 and then make make the new got current. */
2342
2343 static int
2344 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
2345 {
2346 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
2347 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
2348 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2349 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
2350 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
2351 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
2352
2353 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
2354 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
2355 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount <= maxcnt)
2356 {
2357 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
2358 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
2359 }
2360 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
2361 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
2362 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
2363 else if (arg->primary
2364 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount) <= maxcnt)
2365 {
2366 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2367 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
2368 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
2369
2370 bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
2371
2372 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2373 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2374 arg);
2375 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2376 return 0;
2377
2378 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2379 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
2380 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
2381 table anyway. */
2382
2383 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
2384 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
2385
2386 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
2387 + arg->primary->global_gotno;
2388 }
2389 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
2390 else if (arg->current
2391 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount <= maxcnt)
2392 {
2393 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2394 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
2395 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
2396
2397 bfd2got->g = arg->current;
2398
2399 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2400 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2401 arg);
2402 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2403 return 0;
2404
2405 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2406
2407 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
2408 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
2409
2410 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
2411 + arg->current->global_gotno;
2412 }
2413 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
2414 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
2415 overflows anyway. */
2416 else
2417 {
2418 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
2419 arg->current = bfd2got->g;
2420
2421 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount;
2422 }
2423
2424 return 1;
2425 }
2426
2427 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
2428 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
2429 got) to the given VALUE.
2430
2431 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
2432 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
2433 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
2434 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
2435 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
2436 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
2437 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
2438 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
2439 stub. */
2440 static int
2441 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
2442 {
2443 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2444 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
2445 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
2446 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
2447
2448 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
2449 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
2450 {
2451 if (g)
2452 {
2453 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
2454
2455 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
2456 if (arg->info->shared
2457 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
2458 && ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
2459 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
2460 && ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
2461 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
2462 ++arg->needed_relocs;
2463 }
2464 else
2465 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
2466 }
2467
2468 return 1;
2469 }
2470
2471 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
2472 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
2473 static int
2474 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2475 {
2476 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2477
2478 if (entry->abfd != NULL
2479 && entry->symndx == -1
2480 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
2481 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
2482
2483 return 1;
2484 }
2485
2486 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
2487 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
2488 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
2489 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
2490 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
2491 the traversal must be restarted. */
2492 static int
2493 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
2494 {
2495 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2496 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
2497
2498 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
2499 {
2500 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
2501
2502 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2503 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2504 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2505
2506 if (entry->d.h == h)
2507 return 1;
2508
2509 entry->d.h = h;
2510
2511 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
2512 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
2513 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
2514 {
2515 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
2516 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
2517 if (! *entryp)
2518 *entryp = entry;
2519 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
2520 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
2521 process. */
2522 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
2523 return 0;
2524 }
2525 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
2526 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
2527 }
2528
2529 return 1;
2530 }
2531
2532 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
2533 locations. */
2534 static void
2535 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
2536 {
2537 htab_t got_entries;
2538
2539 do
2540 {
2541 got_entries = g->got_entries;
2542
2543 htab_traverse (got_entries,
2544 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
2545 &got_entries);
2546 }
2547 while (got_entries == NULL);
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
2551 the primary GOT. */
2552 static bfd_vma
2553 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2554 {
2555 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
2556 return 0;
2557
2558 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2559 if (! g)
2560 return 0;
2561
2562 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
2563
2564 g = g->next;
2565
2566 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2567 }
2568
2569 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
2570 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
2571
2572 static bfd_boolean
2573 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2574 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
2575 bfd_size_type pages)
2576 {
2577 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
2578 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
2579 struct mips_got_info *gg;
2580 unsigned int assign;
2581
2582 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
2583 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
2584 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
2585 return FALSE;
2586
2587 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
2588 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
2589 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
2590
2591 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
2592 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
2593 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
2594 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
2595 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
2596 return FALSE;
2597
2598 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
2599 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
2600 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
2601 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
2602 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
2603 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (abfd)
2604 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
2605 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO - pages);
2606
2607 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
2608 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
2609 to be the primary GOT. */
2610 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
2611 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
2612 return FALSE;
2613
2614 /* If we find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
2615 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
2616 {
2617 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
2618 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
2619 if (g->next == NULL)
2620 return FALSE;
2621
2622 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
2623 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
2624 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
2625 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
2626 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
2627 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
2628 NULL);
2629 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
2630 return FALSE;
2631 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
2632 }
2633 else
2634 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
2635 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
2636
2637 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
2638 gg = g;
2639 g = g->next;
2640
2641 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
2642 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
2643 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
2644 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
2645 list. */
2646 {
2647 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
2648 void **bfdgotp;
2649
2650 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
2651 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
2652
2653 if (bfdgot == NULL)
2654 return FALSE;
2655
2656 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
2657 bfdgot->g = g;
2658 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
2659
2660 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
2661 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
2662 }
2663
2664 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
2665 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
2666 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
2667 referenced.
2668
2669 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
2670 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
2671 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
2672 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
2673 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
2674 follows IRIX's practice.
2675
2676 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
2677 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
2678 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
2679 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
2680 preserved. */
2681 if (1)
2682 {
2683 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
2684 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
2685 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
2686 }
2687 else
2688 {
2689 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
2690 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
2691 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
2692 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
2693 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
2694 their entries can be omitted. */
2695 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
2696 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
2697 }
2698
2699 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
2700 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
2701 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
2702 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
2703 &set_got_offset_arg);
2704 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
2705 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
2706 &set_got_offset_arg);
2707 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
2708 return FALSE;
2709
2710 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
2711 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
2712 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
2713 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
2714 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
2715 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
2716 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
2717 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
2718 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
2719 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
2720 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
2721 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
2722 points back to the master GOT. */
2723 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
2724 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
2725 assign = 0;
2726 gg->next = gg;
2727
2728 do
2729 {
2730 struct mips_got_info *gn;
2731
2732 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
2733 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
2734 g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
2735 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
2736
2737 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
2738 list that gg points to. */
2739 gn = g->next;
2740 g->next = gg->next;
2741 gg->next = g;
2742 g = gn;
2743
2744 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
2745 stubs. */
2746 if (g)
2747 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
2748 }
2749 while (g);
2750
2751 got->_raw_size = (gg->next->local_gotno
2752 + gg->next->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2753
2754 return TRUE;
2755 }
2756
2757 \f
2758 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
2759 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
2760
2761 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
2762 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
2763 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
2764 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
2765 {
2766 /* According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must be
2767 immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
2768 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
2769 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
2770 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
2771 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC. */
2772 while (relocation < relend)
2773 {
2774 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type)
2775 return relocation;
2776
2777 ++relocation;
2778 }
2779
2780 /* We didn't find it. */
2781 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2782 return NULL;
2783 }
2784
2785 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
2786
2787 static bfd_boolean
2788 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
2789 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
2790 asection **local_sections,
2791 bfd_boolean check_forced)
2792 {
2793 unsigned long r_symndx;
2794 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2795 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2796 size_t extsymoff;
2797
2798 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
2799 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
2800 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2801
2802 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
2803 return TRUE;
2804 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
2805 return TRUE;
2806
2807 if (check_forced)
2808 {
2809 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
2810 was forced local. */
2811 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
2812 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
2813 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
2814 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2815 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2816 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2817 if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0)
2818 return TRUE;
2819 }
2820
2821 return FALSE;
2822 }
2823 \f
2824 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
2825
2826 bfd_vma
2827 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
2828 {
2829 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
2830 /* VALUE is negative. */
2831 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
2832
2833 return value;
2834 }
2835
2836 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
2837 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
2838 BITS. */
2839
2840 static bfd_boolean
2841 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
2842 {
2843 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
2844
2845 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
2846 /* The value is too big. */
2847 return TRUE;
2848 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
2849 /* The value is too small. */
2850 return TRUE;
2851
2852 /* All is well. */
2853 return FALSE;
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Calculate the %high function. */
2857
2858 static bfd_vma
2859 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
2860 {
2861 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
2862 }
2863
2864 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
2865
2866 static bfd_vma
2867 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2868 {
2869 #ifdef BFD64
2870 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
2871 #else
2872 abort ();
2873 return (bfd_vma) -1;
2874 #endif
2875 }
2876
2877 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
2878
2879 static bfd_vma
2880 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2881 {
2882 #ifdef BFD64
2883 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
2884 #else
2885 abort ();
2886 return (bfd_vma) -1;
2887 #endif
2888 }
2889 \f
2890 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
2891
2892 static bfd_boolean
2893 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
2894 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2895 {
2896 flagword flags;
2897 register asection *s;
2898
2899 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
2900 {
2901 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2902 | SEC_READONLY);
2903
2904 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".compact_rel");
2905 if (s == NULL
2906 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags)
2907 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
2908 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
2909 return FALSE;
2910
2911 s->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
2912 }
2913
2914 return TRUE;
2915 }
2916
2917 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
2918
2919 static bfd_boolean
2920 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2921 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
2922 {
2923 flagword flags;
2924 register asection *s;
2925 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2926 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
2927 struct mips_got_info *g;
2928 bfd_size_type amt;
2929
2930 /* This function may be called more than once. */
2931 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2932 if (s)
2933 {
2934 if (! maybe_exclude)
2935 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
2936 return TRUE;
2937 }
2938
2939 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2940 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2941
2942 if (maybe_exclude)
2943 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
2944
2945 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
2946 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
2947 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".got");
2948 if (s == NULL
2949 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags)
2950 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2951 return FALSE;
2952
2953 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
2954 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
2955 are not creating a global offset table. */
2956 bh = NULL;
2957 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
2958 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
2959 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
2960 return FALSE;
2961
2962 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
2963 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
2964 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
2965 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
2966
2967 if (info->shared
2968 && ! bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2969 return FALSE;
2970
2971 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
2972 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2973 if (g == NULL)
2974 return FALSE;
2975 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
2976 g->global_gotno = 0;
2977 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
2978 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
2979 g->bfd2got = NULL;
2980 g->next = NULL;
2981 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
2982 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
2983 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
2984 return FALSE;
2985 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
2986 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
2987 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
2988
2989 return TRUE;
2990 }
2991 \f
2992 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
2993 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
2994 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
2995
2996 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
2997 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
2998 relocation must be JALX.
2999
3000 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3001 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3002 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3003 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
3004
3005 static bfd_reloc_status_type
3006 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3007 asection *input_section,
3008 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3009 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3010 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3011 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3012 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3013 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3014 bfd_boolean save_addend)
3015 {
3016 /* The eventual value we will return. */
3017 bfd_vma value;
3018 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3019 occurring. */
3020 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3021 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3022 shared object file being produced. */
3023 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3024 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3025 relocated. */
3026 bfd_vma p;
3027 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
3028 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3029 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3030 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3031 during execution. */
3032 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3033 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3034 located. */
3035 asection *sec = NULL;
3036 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3037 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3038 symbol. */
3039 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3040 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
3041 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3042 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3043 size_t extsymoff;
3044 unsigned long r_symndx;
3045 int r_type;
3046 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3047 relocation value. */
3048 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3049 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
3050 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3051
3052 /* Parse the relocation. */
3053 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3054 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3055 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3056 + input_section->output_offset
3057 + relocation->r_offset);
3058
3059 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
3060 overflowed_p = FALSE;
3061
3062 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3063 used in the array of hash table entries. */
3064 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3065 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3066 local_sections, FALSE);
3067 was_local_p = local_p;
3068 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3069 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3070 else
3071 {
3072 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3073 must come before globals. */
3074 extsymoff = 0;
3075 }
3076
3077 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
3078 if (local_p)
3079 {
3080 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3081
3082 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3083 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3084
3085 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3086 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3087 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3088 symbol += sym->st_value;
3089 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3090 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3091 {
3092 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3093 addend -= symbol;
3094 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3095 }
3096
3097 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
3098 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3099 ++symbol;
3100
3101 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3102 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3103 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3104 sym->st_name);
3105 if (*namep == '\0')
3106 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3107
3108 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3109 }
3110 else
3111 {
3112 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
3113
3114 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
3115 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3116 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3117 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3118 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3119 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3120 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3121
3122 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3123 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3124
3125 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
3126 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3127 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3128 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3129 {
3130 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3131 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
3132 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16)
3133 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3134
3135 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
3136 }
3137 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
3138 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
3139 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
3140 its defined. */
3141 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3142 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3143 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
3144 {
3145 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
3146 if (sec->output_section)
3147 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
3148 + sec->output_section->vma
3149 + sec->output_offset);
3150 else
3151 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
3152 }
3153 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3154 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
3155 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
3156 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
3157 addresses. */
3158 symbol = 0;
3159 else if (info->shared
3160 && info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
3161 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
3162 symbol = 0;
3163 else if (strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0 ||
3164 strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
3165 {
3166 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
3167 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
3168 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
3169 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
3170 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
3171 somehow as well. */
3172 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
3173 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
3174 symbol = 0;
3175 }
3176 else
3177 {
3178 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
3179 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
3180 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
3181 ((info->shared && info->unresolved_syms_in_shared_libs == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
3182 || (!info->shared && info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
3183 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other)))))
3184 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
3185 symbol = 0;
3186 }
3187
3188 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
3189 }
3190
3191 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
3192 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
3193 a stub. */
3194 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3195 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
3196 || (local_p && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
3197 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
3198 && !mips_elf_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
3199 {
3200 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
3201 have already noticed that we were going to need the
3202 stub. */
3203 if (local_p)
3204 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
3205 else
3206 {
3207 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
3208 sec = h->fn_stub;
3209 }
3210
3211 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3212 }
3213 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
3214 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
3215 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3216 && h != NULL
3217 && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3218 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3219 {
3220 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
3221 out which one to use by seeing which one appears in the input
3222 file. */
3223 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3224 {
3225 asection *o;
3226
3227 sec = NULL;
3228 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
3229 {
3230 if (strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o),
3231 CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
3232 {
3233 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3234 break;
3235 }
3236 }
3237 if (sec == NULL)
3238 sec = h->call_stub;
3239 }
3240 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
3241 sec = h->call_stub;
3242 else
3243 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3244
3245 BFD_ASSERT (sec->_raw_size > 0);
3246 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3247 }
3248
3249 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
3250 special jalx instruction. */
3251 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
3252 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3253 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
3254
3255 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3256 local_sections, TRUE);
3257
3258 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
3259 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
3260 switch (r_type)
3261 {
3262 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
3263 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
3264 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
3265 bind locally. */
3266 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
3267 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
3268 break;
3269 /* Fall through. */
3270
3271 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
3272 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
3273 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
3274 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
3275 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
3276 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
3277 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
3278 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
3279 if (!local_p)
3280 {
3281 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
3282 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
3283 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
3284 as GOT_OFST. */
3285 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3286 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3287 input_bfd,
3288 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h);
3289 if (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
3290 || (info->shared
3291 && (info->symbolic || h->root.dynindx == -1)
3292 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR)))
3293 {
3294 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
3295 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
3296 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
3297 bfd *tmpbfd = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3298 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (tmpbfd, FALSE);
3299 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (tmpbfd, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
3300 }
3301 }
3302 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16)
3303 /* There's no need to create a local GOT entry here; the
3304 calculation for a local GOT16 entry does not involve G. */
3305 break;
3306 else
3307 {
3308 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd,
3309 info, symbol + addend);
3310 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
3311 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3312 }
3313
3314 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
3315 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3316 abfd, input_bfd, g);
3317 break;
3318
3319 case R_MIPS_HI16:
3320 case R_MIPS_LO16:
3321 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
3322 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
3323 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
3324 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
3325 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
3326 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
3327 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj)
3328 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd,
3329 mips_elf_got_info
3330 (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, NULL),
3331 input_bfd);
3332 break;
3333
3334 default:
3335 break;
3336 }
3337
3338 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
3339 switch (r_type)
3340 {
3341 case R_MIPS_NONE:
3342 return bfd_reloc_continue;
3343
3344 case R_MIPS_16:
3345 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
3346 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3347 break;
3348
3349 case R_MIPS_32:
3350 case R_MIPS_REL32:
3351 case R_MIPS_64:
3352 if ((info->shared
3353 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
3354 && h != NULL
3355 && ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
3356 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
3357 && ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
3358 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
3359 && r_symndx != 0
3360 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3361 {
3362 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
3363 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
3364 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
3365 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
3366 linker. */
3367 value = addend;
3368 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
3369 info,
3370 relocation,
3371 h,
3372 sec,
3373 symbol,
3374 &value,
3375 input_section))
3376 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
3377 }
3378 else
3379 {
3380 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
3381 value = symbol + addend;
3382 else
3383 value = addend;
3384 }
3385 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3386 break;
3387
3388 case R_MIPS_PC32:
3389 case R_MIPS_PC64:
3390 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16:
3391 value = symbol + addend - p;
3392 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3393 break;
3394
3395 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
3396 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
3397 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
3398 value = (value >> 2) & howto->dst_mask;
3399 break;
3400
3401 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16:
3402 /* Instead of subtracting 'p' here, we should be subtracting the
3403 equivalent value for the LO part of the reloc, since the value
3404 here is relative to that address. Because that's not easy to do,
3405 we adjust 'addend' in _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(). See also
3406 the comment there for more information. */
3407 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - p);
3408 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3409 break;
3410
3411 case R_MIPS16_26:
3412 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
3413 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
3414 the output file that's different. That's handled in
3415 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
3416 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
3417 case R_MIPS_26:
3418 if (local_p)
3419 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
3420 else
3421 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
3422 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3423 break;
3424
3425 case R_MIPS_HI16:
3426 if (!gp_disp_p)
3427 {
3428 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
3429 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3430 }
3431 else
3432 {
3433 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
3434 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3435 }
3436 break;
3437
3438 case R_MIPS_LO16:
3439 if (!gp_disp_p)
3440 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
3441 else
3442 {
3443 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
3444 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
3445 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
3446 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
3447 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
3448 this:
3449
3450 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
3451 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
3452 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
3453
3454 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
3455 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
3456 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
3457 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
3458 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
3459 not check for overflow here. */
3460 }
3461 break;
3462
3463 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
3464 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
3465 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
3466 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
3467 here. */
3468
3469 /* Fall through. */
3470
3471 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
3472 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
3473 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
3474 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
3475 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
3476 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
3477 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
3478 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
3479 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
3480 if (howto->partial_inplace)
3481 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
3482 value = symbol + addend - gp;
3483 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
3484 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
3485 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
3486 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
3487 to them before. */
3488 if (was_local_p)
3489 value += gp0;
3490 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3491 break;
3492
3493 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
3494 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
3495 if (local_p)
3496 {
3497 bfd_boolean forced;
3498
3499 /* The special case is when the symbol is forced to be local. We
3500 need the full address in the GOT since no R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
3501 follows. */
3502 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3503 local_sections, FALSE);
3504 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
3505 symbol + addend, forced);
3506 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
3507 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3508 value
3509 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3510 abfd, input_bfd, value);
3511 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3512 break;
3513 }
3514
3515 /* Fall through. */
3516
3517 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
3518 got_disp:
3519 value = g;
3520 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3521 break;
3522
3523 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
3524 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
3525 if (!save_addend)
3526 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3527 break;
3528
3529 case R_MIPS_PC16:
3530 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16) + symbol - p;
3531 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3532 break;
3533
3534 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
3535 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
3536 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
3537 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
3538 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
3539 value = g;
3540 value = mips_elf_high (value);
3541 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3542 break;
3543
3544 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
3545 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
3546 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
3547 break;
3548
3549 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
3550 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
3551 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
3552 0. */
3553 if (! local_p)
3554 goto got_disp;
3555 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
3556 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
3557 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3558 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3559 abfd, input_bfd, value);
3560 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3561 break;
3562
3563 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
3564 if (local_p)
3565 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
3566 else
3567 value = addend;
3568 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
3569 break;
3570
3571 case R_MIPS_SUB:
3572 value = symbol - addend;
3573 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3574 break;
3575
3576 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
3577 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
3578 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3579 break;
3580
3581 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
3582 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
3583 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3584 break;
3585
3586 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
3587 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
3588 value &= howto->dst_mask;
3589 break;
3590
3591 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
3592 case R_MIPS_JALR:
3593 /* Both of these may be ignored. R_MIPS_JALR is an optimization
3594 hint; we could improve performance by honoring that hint. */
3595 return bfd_reloc_continue;
3596
3597 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3598 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
3599 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
3600 return bfd_reloc_continue;
3601
3602 default:
3603 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
3604 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3605 }
3606
3607 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
3608 *valuep = value;
3609 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
3610 }
3611
3612 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
3613
3614 static bfd_vma
3615 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
3616 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3617 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
3618 {
3619 bfd_vma x;
3620 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
3621
3622 /* Obtain the bytes. */
3623 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
3624
3625 if ((ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26
3626 || ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
3627 && bfd_little_endian (input_bfd))
3628 /* The two 16-bit words will be reversed on a little-endian system.
3629 See mips_elf_perform_relocation for more details. */
3630 x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16));
3631
3632 return x;
3633 }
3634
3635 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
3636 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
3637 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
3638 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
3639 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
3640 unconditionally converted to JALX.
3641
3642 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
3643
3644 static bfd_boolean
3645 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3646 reloc_howto_type *howto,
3647 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3648 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
3649 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
3650 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
3651 {
3652 bfd_vma x;
3653 bfd_byte *location;
3654 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3655
3656 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
3657 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
3658
3659 /* Obtain the current value. */
3660 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
3661
3662 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
3663 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
3664
3665 /* If this is the R_MIPS16_26 relocation, we must store the
3666 value in a funny way. */
3667 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
3668 {
3669 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
3670 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
3671 are 32 bits.
3672
3673 The format of these instructions is:
3674
3675 +--------------+--------------------------------+
3676 ! JALX ! X! Imm 20:16 ! Imm 25:21 !
3677 +--------------+--------------------------------+
3678 ! Immediate 15:0 !
3679 +-----------------------------------------------+
3680
3681 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
3682 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
3683
3684 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
3685 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
3686 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
3687 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
3688 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
3689 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
3690 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
3691 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
3692 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
3693 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
3694 instruction.
3695
3696 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
3697 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
3698 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
3699 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
3700 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
3701 value as two 16-bit values.
3702
3703 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
3704 defined as
3705
3706 big-endian:
3707 +--------+----------------------+
3708 | | |
3709 | | targ26-16 |
3710 |31 26|25 0|
3711 +--------+----------------------+
3712
3713 little-endian:
3714 +----------+------+-------------+
3715 | | | |
3716 | sub1 | | sub2 |
3717 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
3718 +----------+--------------------+
3719 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
3720 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
3721
3722 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
3723 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
3724 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
3725 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
3726 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff) */
3727
3728 if (!info->relocatable)
3729 /* Shuffle the bits according to the formula above. */
3730 value = (((value & 0x1f0000) << 5)
3731 | ((value & 0x3e00000) >> 5)
3732 | (value & 0xffff));
3733 }
3734 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
3735 {
3736 /* R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
3737 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
3738
3739 +--------------+--------------------------------+
3740 ! EXTEND ! Imm 10:5 ! Imm 15:11 !
3741 +--------------+--------------------------------+
3742 ! Major ! rx ! ry ! Imm 4:0 !
3743 +--------------+--------------------------------+
3744
3745 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
3746 opcode.
3747
3748 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
3749 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
3750 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
3751
3752 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
3753 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
3754 little-endian system. */
3755 value = (((value & 0x7e0) << 16)
3756 | ((value & 0xf800) << 5)
3757 | (value & 0x1f));
3758 }
3759
3760 /* Set the field. */
3761 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
3762
3763 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
3764 if (require_jalx)
3765 {
3766 bfd_boolean ok;
3767 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
3768 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
3769
3770 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
3771 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
3772 {
3773 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
3774 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
3775 }
3776 else
3777 {
3778 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
3779 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
3780 }
3781
3782 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
3783 if (!ok)
3784 {
3785 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3786 (_("%s: %s+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
3787 bfd_archive_filename (input_bfd),
3788 input_section->name,
3789 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
3790 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3791 return FALSE;
3792 }
3793
3794 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
3795 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
3796 }
3797
3798 /* Swap the high- and low-order 16 bits on little-endian systems
3799 when doing a MIPS16 relocation. */
3800 if ((r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL || r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
3801 && bfd_little_endian (input_bfd))
3802 x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16));
3803
3804 /* Put the value into the output. */
3805 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
3806 return TRUE;
3807 }
3808
3809 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
3810
3811 static bfd_boolean
3812 mips_elf_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
3813 {
3814 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
3815
3816 return (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
3817 || strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
3818 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0);
3819 }
3820 \f
3821 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel.dyn section in ABFD. */
3822
3823 static void
3824 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, unsigned int n)
3825 {
3826 asection *s;
3827
3828 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (abfd, FALSE);
3829 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3830
3831 if (s->_raw_size == 0)
3832 {
3833 /* Make room for a null element. */
3834 s->_raw_size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3835 ++s->reloc_count;
3836 }
3837 s->_raw_size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3838 }
3839
3840 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
3841 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
3842 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
3843 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
3844
3845 static bfd_boolean
3846 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
3847 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3848 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3849 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3850 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
3851 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
3852 {
3853 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
3854 bfd_boolean skip;
3855 asection *sreloc;
3856 bfd *dynobj;
3857 int r_type;
3858
3859 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
3860 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3861 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
3862 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
3863 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
3864 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
3865 < sreloc->_raw_size);
3866
3867 skip = FALSE;
3868 outrel[0].r_offset =
3869 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
3870 outrel[1].r_offset =
3871 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
3872 outrel[2].r_offset =
3873 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
3874
3875 #if 0
3876 /* We begin by assuming that the offset for the dynamic relocation
3877 is the same as for the original relocation. We'll adjust this
3878 later to reflect the correct output offsets. */
3879 if (input_section->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS)
3880 {
3881 outrel[1].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset;
3882 outrel[2].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset;
3883 }
3884 else
3885 {
3886 /* Except that in a stab section things are more complex.
3887 Because we compress stab information, the offset given in the
3888 relocation may not be the one we want; we must let the stabs
3889 machinery tell us the offset. */
3890 outrel[1].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset;
3891 outrel[2].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset;
3892 /* If we didn't need the relocation at all, this value will be
3893 -1. */
3894 if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
3895 skip = TRUE;
3896 }
3897 #endif
3898
3899 if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
3900 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
3901 skip = TRUE;
3902 else if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
3903 {
3904 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
3905 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
3906 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
3907 skip = TRUE;
3908 *addendp += symbol;
3909 }
3910
3911 /* If we've decided to skip this relocation, just output an empty
3912 record. Note that R_MIPS_NONE == 0, so that this call to memset
3913 is a way of setting R_TYPE to R_MIPS_NONE. */
3914 if (skip)
3915 memset (outrel, 0, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * 3);
3916 else
3917 {
3918 long indx;
3919 bfd_boolean defined_p;
3920
3921 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
3922 in the relocation. */
3923 if (h != NULL
3924 && (! info->symbolic || (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
3925 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)
3926 /* h->root.dynindx may be -1 if this symbol was marked to
3927 become local. */
3928 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
3929 {
3930 indx = h->root.dynindx;
3931 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
3932 defined_p = ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
3933 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) != 0);
3934 else
3935 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
3936 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
3937 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
3938 undefined symbols. */
3939 defined_p = FALSE;
3940 }
3941 else
3942 {
3943 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
3944 indx = 0;
3945 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
3946 {
3947 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3948 return FALSE;
3949 }
3950 else
3951 {
3952 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
3953 if (indx == 0)
3954 abort ();
3955 }
3956
3957 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
3958 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
3959 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
3960 local symbols because we used to generate them
3961 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
3962 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
3963 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
3964 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
3965 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
3966 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
3967 as well. */
3968 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
3969 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
3970 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
3971 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
3972 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
3973 indx = 0;
3974 defined_p = TRUE;
3975 }
3976
3977 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
3978 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
3979 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
3980 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
3981 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
3982 *addendp += symbol;
3983
3984 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
3985 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
3986 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
3987 R_MIPS_REL32);
3988 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
3989 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
3990 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
3991 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
3992 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
3993 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
3994 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
3995 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
3996 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
3997 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
3998 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
3999 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
4000 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4001 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4002 ? R_MIPS_64
4003 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4004 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4005
4006 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4007 correct location in the output file. */
4008 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4009 + input_section->output_offset);
4010 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4011 + input_section->output_offset);
4012 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4013 + input_section->output_offset);
4014 }
4015
4016 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
4017 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4018 relocation format is non-standard. */
4019 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4020 {
4021 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4022 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4023 (sreloc->contents
4024 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4025 }
4026 else
4027 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4028 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4029 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4030
4031 /* We've now added another relocation. */
4032 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4033
4034 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
4035 will be writing to it. */
4036 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4037 |= SHF_WRITE;
4038
4039 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
4040 if (! skip && IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4041 {
4042 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4043 bfd_byte *cr;
4044
4045 if (scpt)
4046 {
4047 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4048
4049 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4050 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4051 + input_section->output_section->vma
4052 + input_section->output_offset);
4053 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4054 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4055 else
4056 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4057 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4058 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4059
4060 cr = (scpt->contents
4061 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4062 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4063 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4064 + scpt->reloc_count));
4065 ++scpt->reloc_count;
4066 }
4067 }
4068
4069 return TRUE;
4070 }
4071 \f
4072 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
4073
4074 unsigned long
4075 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4076 {
4077 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4078 {
4079 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4080 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4081
4082 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4083 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4084
4085 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4086 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4087
4088 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4089 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4090
4091 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4092 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4093
4094 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4095 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4096
4097 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4098 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
4099
4100 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
4101 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
4102
4103 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
4104 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
4105
4106 default:
4107 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
4108 {
4109 default:
4110 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
4111 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
4112 break;
4113
4114 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
4115 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
4116 break;
4117
4118 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
4119 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
4120 break;
4121
4122 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
4123 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
4124 break;
4125
4126 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
4127 return bfd_mach_mips5;
4128 break;
4129
4130 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
4131 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
4132 break;
4133
4134 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
4135 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
4136 break;
4137
4138 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
4139 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
4140 break;
4141
4142 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
4143 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
4144 break;
4145 }
4146 }
4147
4148 return 0;
4149 }
4150
4151 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
4152
4153 static INLINE char *
4154 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
4155 {
4156 flagword flags;
4157
4158 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
4159 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
4160 {
4161 case 0:
4162 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
4163 return "N32";
4164 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
4165 return "64";
4166 else
4167 return "none";
4168 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
4169 return "O32";
4170 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
4171 return "O64";
4172 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
4173 return "EABI32";
4174 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
4175 return "EABI64";
4176 default:
4177 return "unknown abi";
4178 }
4179 }
4180 \f
4181 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
4182 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
4183 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
4184 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
4185 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
4186 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
4187 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4188 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4189
4190 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
4191 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
4192 definition in a shared library. */
4193 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
4194 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4195 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4196
4197 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
4198 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
4199
4200 void
4201 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
4202 {
4203 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
4204
4205 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
4206 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
4207 {
4208 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
4209 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
4210 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
4211 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
4212 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
4213 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
4214 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
4215 {
4216 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
4217 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
4218 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
4219 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4220 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4221 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4222 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
4223 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4224 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4225 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4226 }
4227 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4228 break;
4229
4230 case SHN_COMMON:
4231 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
4232 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
4233 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
4234 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
4235 break;
4236 /* Fall through. */
4237 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
4238 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
4239 {
4240 /* Initialize the small common section. */
4241 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
4242 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
4243 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4244 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4245 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4246 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
4247 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4248 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4249 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4250 }
4251 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4252 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
4253 break;
4254
4255 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
4256 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4257 break;
4258
4259 #if 0 /* for SGI_COMPAT */
4260 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
4261 asym->section = mips_elf_text_section_ptr;
4262 break;
4263
4264 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
4265 asym->section = mips_elf_data_section_ptr;
4266 break;
4267 #endif
4268 }
4269 }
4270 \f
4271 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
4272 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
4273 same address. For example, if we have code like:
4274
4275 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
4276 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
4277 jalr $25
4278
4279 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
4280 will jump there rather than to .text.
4281
4282 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
4283 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
4284
4285 bfd_boolean
4286 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
4287 {
4288 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
4289 }
4290 \f
4291 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
4292 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
4293 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
4294 a better way. */
4295
4296 bfd_boolean
4297 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
4298 {
4299 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
4300 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
4301 {
4302 bfd_byte buf[4];
4303
4304 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
4305 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
4306
4307 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
4308 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
4309 SEEK_SET) != 0)
4310 return FALSE;
4311 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
4312 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
4313 return FALSE;
4314 }
4315
4316 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
4317 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4318 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
4319 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
4320 {
4321 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
4322
4323 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
4324 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
4325 so that we don't have to read them again.
4326 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
4327 through the section contents to see if there is an
4328 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
4329
4330 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
4331 l = contents;
4332 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
4333 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
4334 {
4335 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
4336
4337 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
4338 &intopt);
4339 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
4340 {
4341 bfd_byte buf[8];
4342
4343 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
4344 (hdr->sh_offset
4345 + (l - contents)
4346 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
4347 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
4348 SEEK_SET) != 0)
4349 return FALSE;
4350 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
4351 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
4352 return FALSE;
4353 }
4354 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
4355 {
4356 bfd_byte buf[4];
4357
4358 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
4359 (hdr->sh_offset
4360 + (l - contents)
4361 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
4362 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
4363 SEEK_SET) != 0)
4364 return FALSE;
4365 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
4366 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
4367 return FALSE;
4368 }
4369 l += intopt.size;
4370 }
4371 }
4372
4373 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
4374 {
4375 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
4376
4377 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
4378 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
4379 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
4380 {
4381 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4382 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
4383 }
4384 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
4385 {
4386 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4387 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
4388 }
4389 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
4390 {
4391 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4392 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
4393 }
4394 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
4395 {
4396 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
4397 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
4398 }
4399 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
4400 {
4401 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
4402 {
4403 unsigned int adjust;
4404
4405 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
4406 if (adjust != 0)
4407 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
4408 }
4409 }
4410 }
4411
4412 return TRUE;
4413 }
4414
4415 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
4416 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
4417 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
4418
4419 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
4420 how to. */
4421
4422 bfd_boolean
4423 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
4424 const char *name)
4425 {
4426 flagword flags = 0;
4427
4428 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
4429 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
4430 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
4431 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
4432 probably get away with this. */
4433 switch (hdr->sh_type)
4434 {
4435 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
4436 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
4437 return FALSE;
4438 break;
4439 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
4440 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
4441 return FALSE;
4442 break;
4443 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
4444 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
4445 return FALSE;
4446 break;
4447 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
4448 if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) != 0)
4449 return FALSE;
4450 break;
4451 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
4452 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
4453 return FALSE;
4454 break;
4455 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
4456 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
4457 return FALSE;
4458 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
4459 break;
4460 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
4461 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
4462 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
4463 return FALSE;
4464 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
4465 break;
4466 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
4467 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
4468 return FALSE;
4469 break;
4470 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
4471 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) != 0)
4472 return FALSE;
4473 break;
4474 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
4475 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) != 0)
4476 return FALSE;
4477 break;
4478 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
4479 if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) != 0)
4480 return FALSE;
4481 break;
4482 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
4483 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
4484 return FALSE;
4485 break;
4486 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
4487 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) != 0
4488 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
4489 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) != 0)
4490 return FALSE;
4491 break;
4492 default:
4493 return FALSE;
4494 }
4495
4496 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name))
4497 return FALSE;
4498
4499 if (flags)
4500 {
4501 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
4502 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
4503 hdr->bfd_section)
4504 | flags)))
4505 return FALSE;
4506 }
4507
4508 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
4509
4510 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
4511 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
4512 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
4513 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
4514 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
4515 {
4516 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
4517 Elf32_RegInfo s;
4518
4519 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
4520 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
4521 return FALSE;
4522 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
4523 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
4524 }
4525
4526 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
4527 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
4528 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
4529 they should agree. */
4530 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
4531 {
4532 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
4533
4534 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
4535 if (contents == NULL)
4536 return FALSE;
4537 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
4538 0, hdr->sh_size))
4539 {
4540 free (contents);
4541 return FALSE;
4542 }
4543 l = contents;
4544 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
4545 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
4546 {
4547 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
4548
4549 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
4550 &intopt);
4551 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
4552 {
4553 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
4554
4555 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
4556 (abfd,
4557 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
4558 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
4559 &intreg);
4560 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
4561 }
4562 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
4563 {
4564 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
4565
4566 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
4567 (abfd,
4568 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
4569 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
4570 &intreg);
4571 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
4572 }
4573 l += intopt.size;
4574 }
4575 free (contents);
4576 }
4577
4578 return TRUE;
4579 }
4580
4581 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
4582 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
4583 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
4584
4585 bfd_boolean
4586 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
4587 {
4588 register const char *name;
4589
4590 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
4591
4592 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
4593 {
4594 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
4595 hdr->sh_info = sec->_raw_size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
4596 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
4597 }
4598 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
4599 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
4600 else if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
4601 {
4602 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
4603 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
4604 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
4605 }
4606 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
4607 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
4608 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
4609 {
4610 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
4611 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
4612 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
4613 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
4614 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4615 else
4616 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
4617 }
4618 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
4619 {
4620 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
4621 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
4622 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
4623 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
4624 {
4625 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
4626 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
4627 else
4628 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
4629 }
4630 else
4631 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
4632 }
4633 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
4634 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
4635 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
4636 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
4637 {
4638 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
4639 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4640 #if 0
4641 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
4642 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
4643 #endif
4644 }
4645 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
4646 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
4647 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
4648 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
4649 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
4650 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
4651 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4652 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
4653 {
4654 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
4655 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
4656 }
4657 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", strlen (".MIPS.content")) == 0)
4658 {
4659 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
4660 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
4661 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
4662 }
4663 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
4664 {
4665 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
4666 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
4667 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
4668 }
4669 else if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) == 0)
4670 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
4671 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
4672 {
4673 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
4674 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
4675 final_write_processing. */
4676 }
4677 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0
4678 || strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
4679 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0)
4680 {
4681 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
4682 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
4683 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
4684 }
4685 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
4686 {
4687 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
4688 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
4689 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
4690 }
4691
4692 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
4693 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
4694 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
4695 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
4696 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
4697
4698 return TRUE;
4699 }
4700
4701 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
4702 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
4703 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
4704 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
4705 the .scommon section. */
4706
4707 bfd_boolean
4708 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4709 asection *sec, int *retval)
4710 {
4711 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
4712 {
4713 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
4714 return TRUE;
4715 }
4716 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
4717 {
4718 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
4719 return TRUE;
4720 }
4721 return FALSE;
4722 }
4723 \f
4724 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
4725 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
4726
4727 bfd_boolean
4728 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4729 const Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
4730 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4731 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
4732 {
4733 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
4734 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
4735 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
4736 {
4737 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
4738 *namep = NULL;
4739 return TRUE;
4740 }
4741
4742 switch (sym->st_shndx)
4743 {
4744 case SHN_COMMON:
4745 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
4746 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
4747 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
4748 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
4749 break;
4750 /* Fall through. */
4751 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
4752 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
4753 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
4754 *valp = sym->st_size;
4755 break;
4756
4757 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
4758 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
4759 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
4760 {
4761 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
4762 asection *elf_text_section;
4763 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
4764
4765 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4766 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
4767 return FALSE;
4768
4769 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
4770 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4771 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
4772 return FALSE;
4773
4774 /* Initialize the section. */
4775
4776 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
4777 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
4778
4779 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
4780 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
4781
4782 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
4783 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
4784 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
4785 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
4786 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
4787 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
4788 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
4789 }
4790 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
4791 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
4792 so I took it out. */
4793 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
4794 break;
4795
4796 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
4797 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
4798 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
4799 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
4800 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
4801 {
4802 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
4803 asection *elf_data_section;
4804 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
4805
4806 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4807 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
4808 return FALSE;
4809
4810 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
4811 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4812 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
4813 return FALSE;
4814
4815 /* Initialize the section. */
4816
4817 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
4818 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
4819
4820 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
4821 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
4822
4823 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
4824 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
4825 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
4826 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
4827 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
4828 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
4829 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
4830 }
4831 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
4832 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
4833 so I took it out. */
4834 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
4835 break;
4836
4837 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
4838 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4839 break;
4840 }
4841
4842 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
4843 && ! info->shared
4844 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
4845 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
4846 {
4847 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4848 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
4849
4850 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
4851 bh = NULL;
4852 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
4853 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
4854 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
4855 return FALSE;
4856
4857 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4858 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
4859 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
4860 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
4861
4862 if (! bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4863 return FALSE;
4864
4865 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
4866 }
4867
4868 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
4869 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
4870 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
4871 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
4872 ++*valp;
4873
4874 return TRUE;
4875 }
4876
4877 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
4878 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
4879 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
4880
4881 bfd_boolean
4882 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
4883 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4884 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
4885 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4886 {
4887 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
4888 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
4889 common in the output file. */
4890 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
4891 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
4892 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
4893
4894 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16
4895 && (sym->st_value & 1) != 0)
4896 --sym->st_value;
4897
4898 return TRUE;
4899 }
4900 \f
4901 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
4902
4903 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
4904
4905 bfd_boolean
4906 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4907 {
4908 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4909 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
4910 flagword flags;
4911 register asection *s;
4912 const char * const *namep;
4913
4914 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
4915 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
4916
4917 /* Mips ABI requests the .dynamic section to be read only. */
4918 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4919 if (s != NULL)
4920 {
4921 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
4922 return FALSE;
4923 }
4924
4925 /* We need to create .got section. */
4926 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
4927 return FALSE;
4928
4929 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, TRUE))
4930 return FALSE;
4931
4932 /* Create .stub section. */
4933 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
4934 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
4935 {
4936 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd));
4937 if (s == NULL
4938 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags | SEC_CODE)
4939 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
4940 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
4941 return FALSE;
4942 }
4943
4944 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
4945 && !info->shared
4946 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
4947 {
4948 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rld_map");
4949 if (s == NULL
4950 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY)
4951 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
4952 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
4953 return FALSE;
4954 }
4955
4956 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
4957 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
4958 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
4959 the linker takes such action. */
4960 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
4961 {
4962 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
4963 {
4964 bh = NULL;
4965 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
4966 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
4967 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
4968 return FALSE;
4969
4970 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4971 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
4972 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
4973 h->type = STT_SECTION;
4974
4975 if (! bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4976 return FALSE;
4977 }
4978
4979 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
4980 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
4981 {
4982 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
4983 return FALSE;
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
4987 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
4988 if (s != NULL)
4989 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
4990 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
4991 if (s != NULL)
4992 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
4993 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
4994 if (s != NULL)
4995 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
4996 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
4997 if (s != NULL)
4998 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
4999 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5000 if (s != NULL)
5001 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5002 }
5003
5004 if (!info->shared)
5005 {
5006 const char *name;
5007
5008 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
5009 bh = NULL;
5010 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5011 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
5012 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5013 return FALSE;
5014
5015 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5016 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
5017 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
5018 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5019
5020 if (! bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5021 return FALSE;
5022
5023 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
5024 {
5025 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
5026 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
5027 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
5028 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
5029 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
5030 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5031
5032 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
5033 bh = NULL;
5034 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5035 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
5036 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5037 return FALSE;
5038
5039 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5040 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
5041 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
5042 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5043
5044 if (! bfd_elf32_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5045 return FALSE;
5046 }
5047 }
5048
5049 return TRUE;
5050 }
5051 \f
5052 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
5053 allocate space in the global offset table. */
5054
5055 bfd_boolean
5056 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5057 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
5058 {
5059 const char *name;
5060 bfd *dynobj;
5061 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5062 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5063 struct mips_got_info *g;
5064 size_t extsymoff;
5065 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
5066 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
5067 asection *sgot;
5068 asection *sreloc;
5069 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5070
5071 if (info->relocatable)
5072 return TRUE;
5073
5074 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5075 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
5076 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
5077 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5078
5079 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
5080
5081 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5082 if (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0)
5083 {
5084 unsigned long r_symndx;
5085
5086 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5087 this is for. */
5088
5089 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5090
5091 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5092 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5093 {
5094 asection *o;
5095
5096 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
5097 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
5098 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
5099 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5100 {
5101 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
5102 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
5103
5104 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
5105 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
5106 || o->reloc_count == 0
5107 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), FN_STUB,
5108 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
5109 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_STUB,
5110 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5111 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_FP_STUB,
5112 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5113 continue;
5114
5115 sec_relocs
5116 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
5117 info->keep_memory);
5118 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
5119 return FALSE;
5120
5121 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
5122 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
5123 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
5124 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
5125 break;
5126
5127 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
5128 free (sec_relocs);
5129
5130 if (r < rend)
5131 break;
5132 }
5133
5134 if (o == NULL)
5135 {
5136 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
5137 not need it. Since this function is called before
5138 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
5139 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
5140 flag. */
5141 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5142 return TRUE;
5143 }
5144
5145 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
5146 this BFD. */
5147 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
5148 {
5149 unsigned long symcount;
5150 asection **n;
5151 bfd_size_type amt;
5152
5153 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
5154 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
5155 else
5156 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5157 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
5158 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5159 if (n == NULL)
5160 return FALSE;
5161 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
5162 }
5163
5164 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
5165
5166 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
5167 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
5168 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
5169 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
5170 }
5171 else
5172 {
5173 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5174
5175 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5176 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5177
5178 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5179
5180 h->fn_stub = sec;
5181 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5182 }
5183 }
5184 else if (strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5185 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5186 {
5187 unsigned long r_symndx;
5188 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5189 asection **loc;
5190
5191 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5192 this is for. */
5193
5194 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5195
5196 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5197 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5198 {
5199 /* This stub was actually built for a static symbol defined
5200 in the same file. We assume that all static symbols in
5201 mips16 code are themselves mips16, so we can simply
5202 discard this stub. Since this function is called before
5203 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we can
5204 easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
5205 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5206 return TRUE;
5207 }
5208
5209 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5210 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5211
5212 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5213
5214 if (strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5215 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
5216 else
5217 loc = &h->call_stub;
5218
5219 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
5220 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
5221 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
5222 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
5223 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. We can also discard this section if we
5224 happen to already know that this is a mips16 function; it is
5225 not necessary to check this here, as it is checked later, but
5226 it is slightly faster to check now. */
5227 if (*loc != NULL || h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
5228 {
5229 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5230 return TRUE;
5231 }
5232
5233 *loc = sec;
5234 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5235 }
5236
5237 if (dynobj == NULL)
5238 {
5239 sgot = NULL;
5240 g = NULL;
5241 }
5242 else
5243 {
5244 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
5245 if (sgot == NULL)
5246 g = NULL;
5247 else
5248 {
5249 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
5250 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
5251 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
5252 }
5253 }
5254
5255 sreloc = NULL;
5256 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5257 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
5258 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
5259 {
5260 unsigned long r_symndx;
5261 unsigned int r_type;
5262 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5263
5264 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
5265 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
5266
5267 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
5268 h = NULL;
5269 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
5270 {
5271 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5272 (_("%s: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
5273 bfd_archive_filename (abfd), name);
5274 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5275 return FALSE;
5276 }
5277 else
5278 {
5279 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
5280
5281 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
5282 if (h != NULL)
5283 {
5284 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5285 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
5286 }
5287 }
5288
5289 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
5290 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
5291 {
5292 switch (r_type)
5293 {
5294 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5295 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5296 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5297 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5298 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5299 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5300 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5301 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
5302 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5303 if (dynobj == NULL)
5304 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
5305 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
5306 return FALSE;
5307 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
5308 break;
5309
5310 case R_MIPS_32:
5311 case R_MIPS_REL32:
5312 case R_MIPS_64:
5313 if (dynobj == NULL
5314 && (info->shared || h != NULL)
5315 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5316 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
5317 break;
5318
5319 default:
5320 break;
5321 }
5322 }
5323
5324 if (!h && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
5325 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
5326 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP))
5327 {
5328 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
5329 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
5330 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
5331 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
5332 R_MIPS_CALL16. We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
5333 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
5334 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
5335 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
5336 rel->r_addend, g))
5337 return FALSE;
5338 }
5339
5340 switch (r_type)
5341 {
5342 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5343 if (h == NULL)
5344 {
5345 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5346 (_("%s: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
5347 bfd_archive_filename (abfd), (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
5348 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5349 return FALSE;
5350 }
5351 /* Fall through. */
5352
5353 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5354 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5355 if (h != NULL)
5356 {
5357 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
5358 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
5359 return FALSE;
5360
5361 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
5362 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
5363 elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol in elflink.h. */
5364 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT;
5365 h->type = STT_FUNC;
5366 }
5367 break;
5368
5369 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5370 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
5371 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
5372 if (h == NULL)
5373 break;
5374 else
5375 {
5376 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
5377 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5378
5379 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5380 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5381 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5382 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
5383
5384 if ((hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR)
5385 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
5386 && ! (hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags
5387 & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL)))
5388 break;
5389 }
5390 /* Fall through. */
5391
5392 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5393 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5394 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5395 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5396 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
5397 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
5398 return FALSE;
5399 break;
5400
5401 case R_MIPS_32:
5402 case R_MIPS_REL32:
5403 case R_MIPS_64:
5404 if ((info->shared || h != NULL)
5405 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5406 {
5407 if (sreloc == NULL)
5408 {
5409 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, TRUE);
5410 if (sreloc == NULL)
5411 return FALSE;
5412 }
5413 #define MIPS_READONLY_SECTION (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)
5414 if (info->shared)
5415 {
5416 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
5417 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
5418 relocs. We make room for this reloc in the
5419 .rel.dyn reloc section. */
5420 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 1);
5421 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
5422 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
5423 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
5424 relocations against the text segment. */
5425 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5426 }
5427 else
5428 {
5429 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
5430
5431 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
5432 defined in a dynamic object. */
5433 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5434 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
5435 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
5436 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
5437 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
5438 are relocations against the text segment. */
5439 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
5440 }
5441
5442 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
5443 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
5444 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
5445 dynamic relocations against it. */
5446 if (h != NULL)
5447 {
5448 if (dynobj == NULL)
5449 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
5450 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
5451 return FALSE;
5452 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
5453 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
5454 return FALSE;
5455 }
5456 }
5457
5458 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5459 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
5460 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
5461 break;
5462
5463 case R_MIPS_26:
5464 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
5465 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
5466 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
5467 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5468 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
5469 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
5470 break;
5471
5472 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
5473 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
5474 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5475 if (!_bfd_elf32_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
5476 return FALSE;
5477 break;
5478
5479 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
5480 used. Record for later use during GC. */
5481 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
5482 if (!_bfd_elf32_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
5483 return FALSE;
5484 break;
5485
5486 default:
5487 break;
5488 }
5489
5490 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
5491 related to taking the function's address. */
5492 switch (r_type)
5493 {
5494 default:
5495 if (h != NULL)
5496 {
5497 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
5498
5499 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5500 mh->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
5501 }
5502 break;
5503 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5504 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5505 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5506 case R_MIPS_JALR:
5507 break;
5508 }
5509
5510 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
5511 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
5512 References from a stub section do not count. */
5513 if (h != NULL
5514 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
5515 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), FN_STUB,
5516 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) != 0
5517 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_STUB,
5518 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) != 0
5519 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_FP_STUB,
5520 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) != 0)
5521 {
5522 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
5523
5524 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5525 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
5526 }
5527 }
5528
5529 return TRUE;
5530 }
5531 \f
5532 bfd_boolean
5533 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
5534 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
5535 bfd_boolean *again)
5536 {
5537 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
5538 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
5539 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5540 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
5541 bfd_byte *free_contents = NULL;
5542 size_t extsymoff;
5543 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
5544 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5545 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
5546
5547 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
5548 *again = FALSE;
5549
5550 if (link_info->relocatable)
5551 return TRUE;
5552
5553 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
5554 link_info->keep_memory);
5555 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
5556 return TRUE;
5557
5558 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
5559 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
5560 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
5561 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5562
5563 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
5564 {
5565 bfd_vma symval;
5566 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
5567 unsigned int r_type;
5568 unsigned long r_symndx;
5569 asection *sym_sec;
5570 unsigned long instruction;
5571
5572 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
5573 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
5574 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
5575 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
5576 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
5577 continue;
5578
5579 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
5580 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
5581 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
5582 {
5583 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
5584 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5585 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5586
5587 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5588 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5589 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5590
5591 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
5592 skip it. */
5593 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5594 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5595 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
5596 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
5597 && ! (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL)))
5598 continue;
5599
5600 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
5601 if (sym_sec->output_section)
5602 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
5603 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
5604 + sym_sec->output_offset);
5605 else
5606 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
5607 }
5608 else
5609 {
5610 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5611
5612 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
5613 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
5614 {
5615 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5616 if (isymbuf == NULL)
5617 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
5618 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
5619 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5620 if (isymbuf == NULL)
5621 goto relax_return;
5622 }
5623
5624 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
5625 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
5626 continue;
5627 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5628 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5629 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
5630 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
5631 else
5632 sym_sec
5633 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
5634 symval = isym->st_value
5635 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
5636 + sym_sec->output_offset;
5637 }
5638
5639 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
5640 branch target. */
5641 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
5642 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
5643
5644 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
5645 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
5646 continue;
5647
5648 sym_offset >>= 2;
5649
5650 /* Check that it's in range. */
5651 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
5652 continue;
5653
5654 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
5655 if (contents == NULL)
5656 {
5657 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
5658 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
5659 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
5660 else
5661 {
5662 contents = bfd_malloc (sec->_raw_size);
5663 if (contents == NULL)
5664 goto relax_return;
5665
5666 free_contents = contents;
5667 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, contents,
5668 0, sec->_raw_size))
5669 goto relax_return;
5670 }
5671 }
5672
5673 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
5674
5675 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
5676 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
5677 instruction = 0x04110000;
5678 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
5679 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
5680 instruction = 0x10000000;
5681 else
5682 continue;
5683
5684 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
5685 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
5686 changed_contents = TRUE;
5687 }
5688
5689 if (contents != NULL
5690 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
5691 {
5692 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
5693 free (contents);
5694 else
5695 {
5696 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
5697 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
5698 }
5699 }
5700 return TRUE;
5701
5702 relax_return:
5703 if (free_contents != NULL)
5704 free (free_contents);
5705 return FALSE;
5706 }
5707 \f
5708 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
5709 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
5710 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
5711 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
5712 understand. */
5713
5714 bfd_boolean
5715 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5716 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5717 {
5718 bfd *dynobj;
5719 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
5720 asection *s;
5721
5722 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5723
5724 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
5725 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
5726 && ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT)
5727 || h->weakdef != NULL
5728 || ((h->elf_link_hash_flags
5729 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0
5730 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags
5731 & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) != 0
5732 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags
5733 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)));
5734
5735 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
5736 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
5737 file. */
5738 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5739 if (! info->relocatable
5740 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
5741 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
5742 || (h->elf_link_hash_flags
5743 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))
5744 {
5745 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj,
5746 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
5747 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
5748 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
5749 against the text segment. */
5750 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5751 }
5752
5753 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
5754 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
5755 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0)
5756 {
5757 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5758 return TRUE;
5759
5760 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
5761 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
5762 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
5763 executable and the shared library. */
5764 if ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)
5765 {
5766 /* We need .stub section. */
5767 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
5768 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
5769 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5770
5771 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5772 h->root.u.def.value = s->_raw_size;
5773
5774 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
5775 h->plt.offset = s->_raw_size;
5776
5777 /* Make room for this stub code. */
5778 s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
5779
5780 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
5781 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
5782 return TRUE;
5783 }
5784 }
5785 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
5786 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) == 0)
5787 {
5788 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
5789 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
5790 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
5791 return TRUE;
5792 }
5793
5794 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
5795 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
5796 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
5797 if (h->weakdef != NULL)
5798 {
5799 BFD_ASSERT (h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5800 || h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
5801 h->root.u.def.section = h->weakdef->root.u.def.section;
5802 h->root.u.def.value = h->weakdef->root.u.def.value;
5803 return TRUE;
5804 }
5805
5806 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
5807 is not a function. */
5808
5809 return TRUE;
5810 }
5811 \f
5812 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
5813 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
5814 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
5815
5816 bfd_boolean
5817 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5818 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5819 {
5820 asection *ri;
5821
5822 bfd *dynobj;
5823 asection *s;
5824 struct mips_got_info *g;
5825 int i;
5826 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
5827 bfd_size_type local_gotno;
5828 bfd *sub;
5829
5830 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
5831 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
5832 if (ri != NULL)
5833 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5834
5835 if (! (info->relocatable
5836 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
5837 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
5838 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
5839
5840 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5841 if (dynobj == NULL)
5842 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
5843 return TRUE;
5844
5845 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
5846 if (s == NULL)
5847 return TRUE;
5848
5849 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
5850 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
5851 required. */
5852 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
5853 {
5854 asection *subsection;
5855
5856 for (subsection = sub->sections;
5857 subsection;
5858 subsection = subsection->next)
5859 {
5860 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
5861 continue;
5862 loadable_size += ((subsection->_raw_size + 0xf)
5863 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
5864 }
5865 }
5866
5867 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
5868 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
5869 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
5870 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
5871 do that here. */
5872 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
5873 return FALSE;
5874
5875 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
5876 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
5877 else
5878 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
5879 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
5880 i = 0;
5881
5882 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
5883 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
5884 rld. */
5885 loadable_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE * (i + 1);
5886
5887 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of
5888 contiguous sections. Is 5 enough? */
5889 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
5890
5891 g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
5892 s->_raw_size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
5893
5894 g->global_gotno = i;
5895 s->_raw_size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
5896
5897 if (s->_raw_size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (output_bfd)
5898 && ! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
5899 return FALSE;
5900
5901 return TRUE;
5902 }
5903
5904 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5905
5906 bfd_boolean
5907 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5908 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5909 {
5910 bfd *dynobj;
5911 asection *s;
5912 bfd_boolean reltext;
5913
5914 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5915 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
5916
5917 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5918 {
5919 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5920 if (info->executable)
5921 {
5922 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
5923 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5924 s->_raw_size
5925 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
5926 s->contents
5927 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
5928 }
5929 }
5930
5931 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
5932 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
5933 memory for them. */
5934 reltext = FALSE;
5935 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5936 {
5937 const char *name;
5938 bfd_boolean strip;
5939
5940 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
5941 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
5942 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
5943
5944 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5945 continue;
5946
5947 strip = FALSE;
5948
5949 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) == 0)
5950 {
5951 if (s->_raw_size == 0)
5952 {
5953 /* We only strip the section if the output section name
5954 has the same name. Otherwise, there might be several
5955 input sections for this output section. FIXME: This
5956 code is probably not needed these days anyhow, since
5957 the linker now does not create empty output sections. */
5958 if (s->output_section != NULL
5959 && strcmp (name,
5960 bfd_get_section_name (s->output_section->owner,
5961 s->output_section)) == 0)
5962 strip = TRUE;
5963 }
5964 else
5965 {
5966 const char *outname;
5967 asection *target;
5968
5969 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
5970 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
5971 If the relocation section is .rel.dyn, we always
5972 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
5973 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
5974 not. */
5975 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
5976 s->output_section);
5977 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
5978 if ((target != NULL
5979 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
5980 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5981 || strcmp (outname, ".rel.dyn") == 0)
5982 reltext = TRUE;
5983
5984 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5985 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5986 if (strcmp (name, ".rel.dyn") != 0)
5987 s->reloc_count = 0;
5988
5989 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
5990 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
5991 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
5992 will move them around between input sections'
5993 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
5994 broken, so don't let it run. */
5995 info->combreloc = 0;
5996 }
5997 }
5998 else if (strncmp (name, ".got", 4) == 0)
5999 {
6000 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
6001 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
6002 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
6003 hash tables. */
6004 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
6005 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
6006 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
6007 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
6008
6009 if (gg->next)
6010 {
6011 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6012 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
6013
6014 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
6015 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
6016 {
6017 unsigned int save_assign;
6018
6019 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
6020
6021 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
6022 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
6023 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
6024 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
6025 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
6026 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
6027 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
6028 &set_got_offset_arg);
6029 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
6030 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
6031 <= g->global_gotno);
6032
6033 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
6034 if (info->shared)
6035 {
6036 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
6037 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
6038 + g->next->global_gotno
6039 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO);
6040 }
6041 }
6042
6043 if (needed_relocs)
6044 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, needed_relocs);
6045 }
6046 }
6047 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
6048 {
6049 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
6050 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
6051 s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
6052 }
6053 else if (! info->shared
6054 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
6055 && strncmp (name, ".rld_map", 8) == 0)
6056 {
6057 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
6058 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
6059 s->_raw_size += 4;
6060 }
6061 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
6062 && strncmp (name, ".compact_rel", 12) == 0)
6063 s->_raw_size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
6064 else if (strncmp (name, ".init", 5) != 0)
6065 {
6066 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
6067 continue;
6068 }
6069
6070 if (strip)
6071 {
6072 _bfd_strip_section_from_output (info, s);
6073 continue;
6074 }
6075
6076 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
6077 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->_raw_size);
6078 if (s->contents == NULL && s->_raw_size != 0)
6079 {
6080 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
6081 return FALSE;
6082 }
6083 }
6084
6085 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6086 {
6087 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
6088 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
6089 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
6090 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
6091 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
6092 if (! info->shared)
6093 {
6094 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
6095 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. */
6096 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
6097 return FALSE;
6098 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6099 {
6100 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6101 return FALSE;
6102 }
6103 }
6104 else
6105 {
6106 /* Shared libraries on traditional mips have DT_DEBUG. */
6107 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6108 {
6109 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6110 return FALSE;
6111 }
6112 }
6113
6114 if (reltext && SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6115 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6116
6117 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
6118 {
6119 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
6120 return FALSE;
6121 }
6122
6123 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
6124 return FALSE;
6125
6126 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE))
6127 {
6128 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
6129 return FALSE;
6130
6131 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
6132 return FALSE;
6133
6134 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
6135 return FALSE;
6136 }
6137
6138 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
6139 return FALSE;
6140
6141 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
6142 return FALSE;
6143
6144 #if 0
6145 /* Time stamps in executable files are a bad idea. */
6146 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP, 0))
6147 return FALSE;
6148 #endif
6149
6150 #if 0 /* FIXME */
6151 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM, 0))
6152 return FALSE;
6153 #endif
6154
6155 #if 0 /* FIXME */
6156 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_IVERSION, 0))
6157 return FALSE;
6158 #endif
6159
6160 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
6161 return FALSE;
6162
6163 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
6164 return FALSE;
6165
6166 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
6167 return FALSE;
6168
6169 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
6170 return FALSE;
6171
6172 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
6173 return FALSE;
6174
6175 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
6176 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
6177 return FALSE;
6178
6179 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
6180 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
6181 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
6182 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
6183 return FALSE;
6184 }
6185
6186 return TRUE;
6187 }
6188 \f
6189 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
6190
6191 bfd_boolean
6192 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6193 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
6194 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6195 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6196 asection **local_sections)
6197 {
6198 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6199 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6200 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6201 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
6202 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6203
6204 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
6205 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6206 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
6207 {
6208 const char *name;
6209 bfd_vma value;
6210 reloc_howto_type *howto;
6211 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
6212 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
6213 REL relocation. */
6214 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
6215 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6216 const char *msg;
6217
6218 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
6219 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
6220 {
6221 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
6222 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
6223 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
6224 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
6225 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
6226 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
6227 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
6228
6229 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
6230 of the reloc. */
6231 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6232 rel->r_offset += 4;
6233 }
6234 else
6235 /* NewABI defaults to RELA relocations. */
6236 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
6237 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
6238 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
6239 (input_bfd, input_section,
6240 rel - relocs)));
6241
6242 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
6243 {
6244 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6245
6246 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
6247 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
6248 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
6249 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
6250 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
6251 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
6252 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
6253 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
6254 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
6255 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
6256 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
6257 {
6258 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
6259 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
6260
6261 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
6262 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
6263 contents);
6264 addend &= howto->src_mask;
6265
6266 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
6267 combination of the addend stored in two different
6268 relocations. */
6269 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
6270 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16
6271 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
6272 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
6273 local_sections, FALSE)))
6274 {
6275 bfd_vma l;
6276 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
6277 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
6278 unsigned int lo;
6279
6280 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
6281 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
6282 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
6283 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
6284 the LO16 value.)
6285
6286 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation. */
6287 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
6288 lo = R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16;
6289 else
6290 lo = R_MIPS_LO16;
6291 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd, lo,
6292 rel, relend);
6293 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
6294 return FALSE;
6295
6296 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
6297 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, lo, FALSE);
6298 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto, lo16_relocation,
6299 input_bfd, contents);
6300 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
6301 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
6302 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
6303
6304 addend <<= 16;
6305
6306 /* Compute the combined addend. */
6307 addend += l;
6308
6309 /* If PC-relative, subtract the difference between the
6310 address of the LO part of the reloc and the address of
6311 the HI part. The relocation is relative to the LO
6312 part, but mips_elf_calculate_relocation() doesn't
6313 know its address or the difference from the HI part, so
6314 we subtract that difference here. See also the
6315 comment in mips_elf_calculate_relocation(). */
6316 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
6317 addend -= (lo16_relocation->r_offset - rel->r_offset);
6318 }
6319 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
6320 {
6321 /* The addend is scrambled in the object file. See
6322 mips_elf_perform_relocation for details on the
6323 format. */
6324 addend = (((addend & 0x1f0000) >> 5)
6325 | ((addend & 0x7e00000) >> 16)
6326 | (addend & 0x1f));
6327 }
6328 else
6329 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
6330 }
6331 else
6332 addend = rel->r_addend;
6333 }
6334
6335 if (info->relocatable)
6336 {
6337 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6338 unsigned long r_symndx;
6339
6340 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
6341 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6342 rel->r_offset -= 4;
6343
6344 /* Since we're just relocating, all we need to do is copy
6345 the relocations back out to the object file, unless
6346 they're against a section symbol, in which case we need
6347 to adjust by the section offset, or unless they're GP
6348 relative in which case we need to adjust by the amount
6349 that we're adjusting GP in this relocatable object. */
6350
6351 if (! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections,
6352 FALSE))
6353 /* There's nothing to do for non-local relocations. */
6354 continue;
6355
6356 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
6357 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
6358 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
6359 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
6360 addend -= (_bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
6361 - _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd));
6362
6363 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6364 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
6365 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
6366 /* Adjust the addend appropriately. */
6367 addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
6368
6369 if (rela_relocation_p)
6370 /* If this is a RELA relocation, just update the addend. */
6371 rel->r_addend = addend;
6372 else
6373 {
6374 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
6375 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
6376 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
6377 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
6378 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
6379 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
6380 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
6381 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
6382 else
6383 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
6384
6385 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
6386 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
6387 source of the addend in the final link. */
6388 addend &= howto->src_mask;
6389
6390 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
6391 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
6392 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
6393 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
6394 but for endianness. */
6395 {
6396 bfd_vma sign_bits;
6397 bfd_vma low_bits;
6398 bfd_vma high_bits;
6399
6400 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
6401 #ifdef BFD64
6402 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
6403 #else
6404 sign_bits = -1;
6405 #endif
6406 else
6407 sign_bits = 0;
6408
6409 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
6410 do two separate stores. */
6411 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6412 {
6413 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
6414 first. */
6415 low_bits = sign_bits;
6416 high_bits = addend;
6417 }
6418 else
6419 {
6420 low_bits = addend;
6421 high_bits = sign_bits;
6422 }
6423 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
6424 contents + rel->r_offset);
6425 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
6426 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
6427 continue;
6428 }
6429
6430 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
6431 input_bfd, input_section,
6432 contents, FALSE))
6433 return FALSE;
6434 }
6435
6436 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
6437 continue;
6438 }
6439
6440 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
6441 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
6442 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
6443 for the next. */
6444 if (rel + 1 < relend
6445 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
6446 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
6447 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
6448 else
6449 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
6450
6451 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
6452 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
6453 input_section, info, rel,
6454 addend, howto, local_syms,
6455 local_sections, &value,
6456 &name, &require_jalx,
6457 use_saved_addend_p))
6458 {
6459 case bfd_reloc_continue:
6460 /* There's nothing to do. */
6461 continue;
6462
6463 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
6464 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
6465 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
6466 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
6467 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
6468 continue;
6469
6470 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
6471 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
6472 info->callbacks->warning
6473 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
6474 return FALSE;
6475
6476 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
6477 if (use_saved_addend_p)
6478 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
6479 a given location. */
6480 ;
6481 else
6482 {
6483 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
6484 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
6485 (info, name, howto->name, 0,
6486 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
6487 return FALSE;
6488 }
6489 break;
6490
6491 case bfd_reloc_ok:
6492 break;
6493
6494 default:
6495 abort ();
6496 break;
6497 }
6498
6499 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
6500 until we reach the last one. */
6501 if (use_saved_addend_p)
6502 {
6503 addend = value;
6504 continue;
6505 }
6506
6507 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
6508 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
6509 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
6510 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
6511 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
6512 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
6513 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
6514 only a 32-bit VMA. */
6515 {
6516 bfd_vma sign_bits;
6517 bfd_vma low_bits;
6518 bfd_vma high_bits;
6519
6520 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
6521 #ifdef BFD64
6522 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
6523 #else
6524 sign_bits = -1;
6525 #endif
6526 else
6527 sign_bits = 0;
6528
6529 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
6530 do two separate stores. */
6531 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6532 {
6533 /* Undo what we did above. */
6534 rel->r_offset -= 4;
6535 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
6536 first. */
6537 low_bits = sign_bits;
6538 high_bits = value;
6539 }
6540 else
6541 {
6542 low_bits = value;
6543 high_bits = sign_bits;
6544 }
6545 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
6546 contents + rel->r_offset);
6547 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
6548 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
6549 continue;
6550 }
6551
6552 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
6553 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
6554 input_bfd, input_section,
6555 contents, require_jalx))
6556 return FALSE;
6557 }
6558
6559 return TRUE;
6560 }
6561 \f
6562 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
6563 adjust it appropriately now. */
6564
6565 static void
6566 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6567 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6568 {
6569 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
6570 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
6571 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
6572 "_ftext",
6573 "_etext",
6574 "__dso_displacement",
6575 "__elf_header",
6576 "__program_header_table",
6577 NULL
6578 };
6579
6580 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
6581 "_fdata",
6582 "_edata",
6583 "_end",
6584 "_fbss",
6585 NULL
6586 };
6587
6588 const char* const *p;
6589 int i;
6590
6591 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
6592 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
6593 *p;
6594 ++p)
6595 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
6596 {
6597 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
6598 IRIX6 linker. */
6599 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6600 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
6601
6602 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
6603 if (i == 0)
6604 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
6605 else
6606 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
6607
6608 break;
6609 }
6610 }
6611
6612 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
6613 dynamic sections here. */
6614
6615 bfd_boolean
6616 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
6617 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6618 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6619 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6620 {
6621 bfd *dynobj;
6622 bfd_vma gval;
6623 asection *sgot;
6624 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
6625 const char *name;
6626
6627 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6628 gval = sym->st_value;
6629
6630 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
6631 {
6632 asection *s;
6633 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE];
6634
6635 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
6636
6637 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
6638
6639 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6640 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6641 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6642
6643 /* FIXME: Can h->dynindex be more than 64K? */
6644 if (h->dynindx & 0xffff0000)
6645 return FALSE;
6646
6647 /* Fill the stub. */
6648 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub);
6649 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + 4);
6650 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + 8);
6651 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16 (output_bfd) + h->dynindx, stub + 12);
6652
6653 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->_raw_size);
6654 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
6655
6656 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
6657 only for the referenced symbol. */
6658 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
6659
6660 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
6661 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
6662 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
6663 gval = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset + h->plt.offset;
6664 sym->st_value = gval;
6665 }
6666
6667 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
6668 || (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0);
6669
6670 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6671 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
6672 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6673 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6674 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6675
6676 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
6677 the symbols that need them. */
6678 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
6679 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
6680 {
6681 bfd_vma offset;
6682 bfd_vma value;
6683
6684 value = sym->st_value;
6685 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h);
6686 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
6687 }
6688
6689 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1)
6690 {
6691 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
6692 bfd_vma entry;
6693 bfd_vma offset;
6694
6695 gg = g;
6696
6697 e.abfd = output_bfd;
6698 e.symndx = -1;
6699 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
6700
6701 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
6702 {
6703 if (g->got_entries
6704 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
6705 &e)))
6706 {
6707 offset = p->gotidx;
6708 if (info->shared
6709 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
6710 && p->d.h != NULL
6711 && ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
6712 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
6713 && ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
6714 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
6715 {
6716 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
6717 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
6718 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
6719 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
6720 appropriate addend. */
6721 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
6722
6723 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
6724 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6725 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
6726 else
6727 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
6728 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
6729
6730 entry = 0;
6731 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
6732 (output_bfd, info, rel,
6733 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
6734 return FALSE;
6735 }
6736 else
6737 entry = sym->st_value;
6738 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
6739 }
6740 }
6741 }
6742
6743 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
6744 name = h->root.root.string;
6745 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
6746 || strcmp (name, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
6747 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
6748 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
6749 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
6750 {
6751 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
6752 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6753 sym->st_value = 1;
6754 }
6755 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
6756 {
6757 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
6758 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6759 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
6760 }
6761 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6762 {
6763 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
6764 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
6765 {
6766 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6767 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
6768 sym->st_value = 0;
6769 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
6770 }
6771 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
6772 {
6773 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6774 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
6775 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
6776 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
6777 }
6778 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
6779 {
6780 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
6781 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
6782 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
6783 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
6784 }
6785 }
6786
6787 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
6788 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
6789 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
6790
6791 if (! info->shared)
6792 {
6793 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
6794 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
6795 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
6796 {
6797 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
6798 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6799 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
6800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
6801 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
6802 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
6803 }
6804 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
6805 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
6806 {
6807 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
6808 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
6809 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
6810 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
6811 != NULL);
6812 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
6813 }
6814 }
6815
6816 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
6817 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16
6818 && (sym->st_value & 1) != 0)
6819 --sym->st_value;
6820
6821 return TRUE;
6822 }
6823
6824 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
6825
6826 bfd_boolean
6827 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6828 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6829 {
6830 bfd *dynobj;
6831 asection *sdyn;
6832 asection *sgot;
6833 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
6834
6835 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6836
6837 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
6838
6839 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6840 if (sgot == NULL)
6841 gg = g = NULL;
6842 else
6843 {
6844 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6845 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6846 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
6847 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
6848 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6849 }
6850
6851 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6852 {
6853 bfd_byte *b;
6854
6855 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
6856 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6857
6858 for (b = sdyn->contents;
6859 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->_raw_size;
6860 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
6861 {
6862 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
6863 const char *name;
6864 size_t elemsize;
6865 asection *s;
6866 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
6867
6868 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
6869 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
6870
6871 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
6872 swap_out_p = TRUE;
6873
6874 switch (dyn.d_tag)
6875 {
6876 case DT_RELENT:
6877 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6878 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6879 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
6880 break;
6881
6882 case DT_STRSZ:
6883 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
6884 dyn.d_un.d_val =
6885 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
6886 break;
6887
6888 case DT_PLTGOT:
6889 name = ".got";
6890 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
6891 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6892 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
6893 break;
6894
6895 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
6896 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
6897 break;
6898
6899 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
6900 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
6901 break;
6902
6903 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
6904 time ((time_t *) &dyn.d_un.d_val);
6905 break;
6906
6907 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
6908 /* XXX FIXME: */
6909 swap_out_p = FALSE;
6910 break;
6911
6912 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
6913 /* XXX FIXME: */
6914 swap_out_p = FALSE;
6915 break;
6916
6917 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
6918 s = output_bfd->sections;
6919 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6920 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
6921 break;
6922
6923 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
6924 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
6925 break;
6926
6927 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
6928 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
6929 entry of the first external symbol that is not
6930 referenced within the same object. */
6931 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
6932 break;
6933
6934 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
6935 if (gg->global_gotsym)
6936 {
6937 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
6938 break;
6939 }
6940 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
6941 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
6942 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
6943
6944 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
6945 name = ".dynsym";
6946 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
6947 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
6948 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6949
6950 if (s->_cooked_size != 0)
6951 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_cooked_size / elemsize;
6952 else
6953 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_raw_size / elemsize;
6954 break;
6955
6956 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
6957 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
6958 break;
6959
6960 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
6961 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
6962 break;
6963
6964 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
6965 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
6966 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
6967 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
6968 break;
6969
6970 case DT_RELSZ:
6971 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
6972 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
6973 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
6974 are trailing null entries. */
6975 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6976 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
6977 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
6978 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
6979 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
6980 break;
6981
6982 default:
6983 swap_out_p = FALSE;
6984 break;
6985 }
6986
6987 if (swap_out_p)
6988 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
6989 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
6990 }
6991 }
6992
6993 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
6994 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
6995 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
6996 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->_raw_size > 0)
6997 {
6998 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
6999 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000,
7000 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7001 }
7002
7003 if (sgot != NULL)
7004 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
7005 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7006
7007 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
7008 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
7009 {
7010 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
7011 bfd_vma addend = 0;
7012
7013 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
7014 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
7015
7016 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7017 {
7018 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno;
7019
7020 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
7021 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7022 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
7023 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7024
7025 if (! info->shared)
7026 continue;
7027
7028 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
7029 {
7030 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
7031 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7032 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
7033 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
7034 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
7035 0, &addend, sgot)))
7036 return FALSE;
7037 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
7038 }
7039 }
7040 }
7041
7042 {
7043 asection *s;
7044 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
7045
7046 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
7047 {
7048 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
7049 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
7050 if (s != NULL)
7051 {
7052 cpt.id1 = 1;
7053 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
7054 cpt.id2 = 2;
7055 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
7056 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
7057 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
7058 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
7059 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
7060 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
7061 s->contents));
7062
7063 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
7064 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7065 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7066 if (s != NULL)
7067 {
7068 file_ptr dummy_offset;
7069
7070 BFD_ASSERT (s->_raw_size >= MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7071 dummy_offset = s->_raw_size - MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
7072 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
7073 MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7074 }
7075 }
7076 }
7077
7078 /* We need to sort the entries of the dynamic relocation section. */
7079
7080 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7081
7082 if (s != NULL
7083 && s->_raw_size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
7084 {
7085 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
7086
7087 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
7088 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7089 sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
7090 else
7091 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7092 sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs);
7093 }
7094 }
7095
7096 return TRUE;
7097 }
7098
7099
7100 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
7101
7102 static void
7103 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
7104 {
7105 flagword val;
7106
7107 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
7108 {
7109 default:
7110 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
7111 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
7112 break;
7113
7114 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
7115 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
7116 break;
7117
7118 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
7119 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
7120 break;
7121
7122 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
7123 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
7124 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
7125 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
7126 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
7127 break;
7128
7129 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
7130 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
7131 break;
7132
7133 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
7134 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
7135 break;
7136
7137 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
7138 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
7139 break;
7140
7141 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
7142 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
7143 break;
7144
7145 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
7146 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
7147 break;
7148
7149 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
7150 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
7151 break;
7152
7153 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
7154 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
7155 break;
7156
7157 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
7158 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
7159 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
7160 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
7161 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
7162 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
7163 break;
7164
7165 case bfd_mach_mips5:
7166 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
7167 break;
7168
7169 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
7170 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
7171 break;
7172
7173 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
7174 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
7175 break;
7176
7177 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
7178 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
7179 break;
7180
7181 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
7182 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
7183 break;
7184
7185 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
7186 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
7187 break;
7188 }
7189 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
7190 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
7191
7192 }
7193
7194
7195 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
7196 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
7197 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7198
7199 void
7200 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
7201 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7202 {
7203 unsigned int i;
7204 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
7205 const char *name;
7206 asection *sec;
7207
7208 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
7209 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
7210 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
7211 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
7212 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
7213
7214 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
7215 info for each special section. */
7216 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
7217 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
7218 i++, hdrpp++)
7219 {
7220 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
7221 {
7222 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
7223 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
7224 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
7225 if (sec != NULL)
7226 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7227 break;
7228
7229 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
7230 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
7231 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
7232 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
7233 && strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0);
7234 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
7235 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
7236 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7237 break;
7238
7239 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
7240 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
7241 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
7242 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
7243 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content",
7244 sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) == 0);
7245 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
7246 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
7247 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
7248 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7249 break;
7250
7251 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
7252 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
7253 if (sec != NULL)
7254 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7255 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
7256 if (sec != NULL)
7257 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7258 break;
7259
7260 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
7261 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
7262 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
7263 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
7264 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0)
7265 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
7266 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
7267 else
7268 {
7269 BFD_ASSERT (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
7270 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0);
7271 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
7272 (name
7273 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
7274 }
7275 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
7276 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
7277 break;
7278
7279 }
7280 }
7281 }
7282 \f
7283 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
7284 segments. */
7285
7286 int
7287 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd)
7288 {
7289 asection *s;
7290 int ret = 0;
7291
7292 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
7293 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
7294 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
7295 ++ret;
7296
7297 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
7298 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
7299 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
7300 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
7301 ++ret;
7302
7303 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
7304 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
7305 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
7306 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
7307 ++ret;
7308
7309 return ret;
7310 }
7311
7312 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
7313
7314 bfd_boolean
7315 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
7316 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7317 {
7318 asection *s;
7319 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
7320 bfd_size_type amt;
7321
7322 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
7323 segment. */
7324 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
7325 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7326 {
7327 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
7328 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
7329 break;
7330 if (m == NULL)
7331 {
7332 amt = sizeof *m;
7333 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7334 if (m == NULL)
7335 return FALSE;
7336
7337 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
7338 m->count = 1;
7339 m->sections[0] = s;
7340
7341 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
7342 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
7343 while (*pm != NULL
7344 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
7345 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
7346 pm = &(*pm)->next;
7347
7348 m->next = *pm;
7349 *pm = m;
7350 }
7351 }
7352
7353 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
7354 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
7355 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
7356 table. */
7357 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
7358 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
7359 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
7360 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
7361 now. */
7362 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
7363 {
7364 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
7365 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
7366 break;
7367
7368 if (s)
7369 {
7370 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
7371
7372 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
7373 while (*pm != NULL
7374 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
7375 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
7376 pm = &(*pm)->next;
7377
7378 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7379 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7380 options_segment->next = *pm;
7381 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
7382 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
7383 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
7384 options_segment->count = 1;
7385 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
7386 *pm = options_segment;
7387 }
7388 }
7389 else
7390 {
7391 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
7392 {
7393 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
7394 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
7395 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
7396 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
7397 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
7398 {
7399 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
7400 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
7401 break;
7402 if (m == NULL)
7403 {
7404 amt = sizeof *m;
7405 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7406 if (m == NULL)
7407 return FALSE;
7408
7409 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
7410
7411 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
7412 if (s == NULL)
7413 {
7414 m->count = 0;
7415 m->p_flags = 0;
7416 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
7417 }
7418 else
7419 {
7420 m->count = 1;
7421 m->sections[0] = s;
7422 }
7423
7424 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
7425 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
7426 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
7427 pm = &(*pm)->next;
7428 if (*pm != NULL)
7429 pm = &(*pm)->next;
7430
7431 m->next = *pm;
7432 *pm = m;
7433 }
7434 }
7435 }
7436 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
7437 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
7438 between. */
7439 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
7440 pm = &(*pm)->next)
7441 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
7442 break;
7443 m = *pm;
7444 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
7445 {
7446 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
7447 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
7448 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
7449 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
7450 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
7451 {
7452 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
7453 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
7454 }
7455 }
7456 if (m != NULL
7457 && m->count == 1 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
7458 {
7459 static const char *sec_names[] =
7460 {
7461 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
7462 };
7463 bfd_vma low, high;
7464 unsigned int i, c;
7465 struct elf_segment_map *n;
7466
7467 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
7468 high = 0;
7469 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
7470 {
7471 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
7472 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7473 {
7474 bfd_size_type sz;
7475
7476 if (low > s->vma)
7477 low = s->vma;
7478 sz = s->_cooked_size;
7479 if (sz == 0)
7480 sz = s->_raw_size;
7481 if (high < s->vma + sz)
7482 high = s->vma + sz;
7483 }
7484 }
7485
7486 c = 0;
7487 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7488 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
7489 && s->vma >= low
7490 && ((s->vma
7491 + (s->_cooked_size !=
7492 0 ? s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high))
7493 ++c;
7494
7495 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7496 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7497 if (n == NULL)
7498 return FALSE;
7499 *n = *m;
7500 n->count = c;
7501
7502 i = 0;
7503 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7504 {
7505 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
7506 && s->vma >= low
7507 && ((s->vma
7508 + (s->_cooked_size != 0 ?
7509 s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high))
7510 {
7511 n->sections[i] = s;
7512 ++i;
7513 }
7514 }
7515
7516 *pm = n;
7517 }
7518 }
7519
7520 return TRUE;
7521 }
7522 \f
7523 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
7524 relocation. */
7525
7526 asection *
7527 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
7528 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7529 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7530 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
7531 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7532 {
7533 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
7534
7535 if (h != NULL)
7536 {
7537 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
7538 {
7539 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7540 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
7541 break;
7542
7543 default:
7544 switch (h->root.type)
7545 {
7546 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
7547 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
7548 return h->root.u.def.section;
7549
7550 case bfd_link_hash_common:
7551 return h->root.u.c.p->section;
7552
7553 default:
7554 break;
7555 }
7556 }
7557 }
7558 else
7559 return bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
7560
7561 return NULL;
7562 }
7563
7564 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
7565
7566 bfd_boolean
7567 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7568 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7569 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7570 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7571 {
7572 #if 0
7573 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7574 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7575 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
7576 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
7577 unsigned long r_symndx;
7578 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7579
7580 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7581 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
7582 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
7583
7584 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
7585 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
7586 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
7587 {
7588 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
7589 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7590 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7591 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7592 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
7593 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
7594 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
7595 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
7596 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
7597 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
7598 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
7599 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
7600 break;
7601
7602 default:
7603 break;
7604 }
7605 #endif
7606
7607 return TRUE;
7608 }
7609 \f
7610 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
7611 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
7612 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
7613 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
7614
7615 void
7616 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
7617 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
7618 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
7619 {
7620 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
7621
7622 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (bed, dir, ind);
7623
7624 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
7625 return;
7626
7627 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
7628 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
7629 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
7630 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
7631 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
7632 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
7633 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
7634 }
7635
7636 void
7637 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7638 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
7639 bfd_boolean force_local)
7640 {
7641 bfd *dynobj;
7642 asection *got;
7643 struct mips_got_info *g;
7644 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7645
7646 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
7647 if (h->forced_local)
7648 return;
7649 h->forced_local = force_local;
7650
7651 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7652 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local)
7653 {
7654 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7655 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
7656
7657 if (g->next)
7658 {
7659 struct mips_got_entry e;
7660 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
7661
7662 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
7663 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
7664 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
7665 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
7666 the upper limit of global entries. */
7667 e.abfd = dynobj;
7668 e.symndx = -1;
7669 e.d.h = h;
7670
7671 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
7672 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
7673 {
7674 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
7675 g->local_gotno++;
7676 g->global_gotno--;
7677 }
7678
7679 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
7680 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
7681 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
7682 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
7683 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
7684 {
7685 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
7686 gg->assigned_gotno--;
7687 }
7688 }
7689 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
7690 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
7691 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
7692 global. */
7693 g->local_gotno++;
7694 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
7695 {
7696 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
7697 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
7698 instead. */
7699 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
7700 g->local_gotno++;
7701 g->global_gotno--;
7702 }
7703 }
7704
7705 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
7706 }
7707 \f
7708 #define PDR_SIZE 32
7709
7710 bfd_boolean
7711 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
7712 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7713 {
7714 asection *o;
7715 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
7716 unsigned char *tdata;
7717 size_t i, skip;
7718
7719 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
7720 if (! o)
7721 return FALSE;
7722 if (o->_raw_size == 0)
7723 return FALSE;
7724 if (o->_raw_size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
7725 return FALSE;
7726 if (o->output_section != NULL
7727 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
7728 return FALSE;
7729
7730 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE);
7731 if (! tdata)
7732 return FALSE;
7733
7734 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
7735 info->keep_memory);
7736 if (!cookie->rels)
7737 {
7738 free (tdata);
7739 return FALSE;
7740 }
7741
7742 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
7743 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
7744
7745 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
7746 {
7747 if (MNAME(abfd,_bfd_elf,reloc_symbol_deleted_p) (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
7748 {
7749 tdata[i] = 1;
7750 skip ++;
7751 }
7752 }
7753
7754 if (skip != 0)
7755 {
7756 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
7757 o->_cooked_size = o->_raw_size - skip * PDR_SIZE;
7758 ret = TRUE;
7759 }
7760 else
7761 free (tdata);
7762
7763 if (! info->keep_memory)
7764 free (cookie->rels);
7765
7766 return ret;
7767 }
7768
7769 bfd_boolean
7770 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
7771 {
7772 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
7773 return TRUE;
7774 return FALSE;
7775 }
7776
7777 bfd_boolean
7778 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd, asection *sec,
7779 bfd_byte *contents)
7780 {
7781 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
7782 int i;
7783
7784 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
7785 return FALSE;
7786
7787 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
7788 return FALSE;
7789
7790 to = contents;
7791 end = contents + sec->_raw_size;
7792 for (from = contents, i = 0;
7793 from < end;
7794 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
7795 {
7796 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
7797 continue;
7798 if (to != from)
7799 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
7800 to += PDR_SIZE;
7801 }
7802 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
7803 sec->output_offset, sec->_cooked_size);
7804 return TRUE;
7805 }
7806 \f
7807 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
7808 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
7809
7810 struct mips_elf_find_line
7811 {
7812 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
7813 struct ecoff_find_line i;
7814 };
7815
7816 bfd_boolean
7817 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
7818 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
7819 const char **filename_ptr,
7820 const char **functionname_ptr,
7821 unsigned int *line_ptr)
7822 {
7823 asection *msec;
7824
7825 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7826 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7827 line_ptr))
7828 return TRUE;
7829
7830 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7831 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7832 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
7833 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
7834 return TRUE;
7835
7836 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
7837 if (msec != NULL)
7838 {
7839 flagword origflags;
7840 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
7841 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
7842 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
7843
7844 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
7845 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
7846 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
7847 origflags = msec->flags;
7848 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
7849 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
7850
7851 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
7852 if (fi == NULL)
7853 {
7854 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
7855 char *fraw_src;
7856 char *fraw_end;
7857 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
7858 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
7859
7860 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7861 if (fi == NULL)
7862 {
7863 msec->flags = origflags;
7864 return FALSE;
7865 }
7866
7867 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
7868 {
7869 msec->flags = origflags;
7870 return FALSE;
7871 }
7872
7873 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
7874 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
7875 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
7876 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
7877 {
7878 msec->flags = origflags;
7879 return FALSE;
7880 }
7881 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
7882 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
7883 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
7884 fraw_end = (fraw_src
7885 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
7886 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
7887 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
7888
7889 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
7890
7891 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
7892 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
7893 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
7894 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
7895 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
7896 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
7897 }
7898
7899 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
7900 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7901 line_ptr))
7902 {
7903 msec->flags = origflags;
7904 return TRUE;
7905 }
7906
7907 msec->flags = origflags;
7908 }
7909
7910 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
7911
7912 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7913 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7914 line_ptr);
7915 }
7916 \f
7917 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
7918 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
7919 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
7920
7921 bfd_boolean
7922 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
7923 const void *location,
7924 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
7925 {
7926 if (strcmp (section->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
7927 {
7928 bfd_byte *c;
7929
7930 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
7931 {
7932 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
7933 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7934 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
7935 return FALSE;
7936 }
7937 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
7938 if (c == NULL)
7939 {
7940 bfd_size_type size;
7941
7942 if (section->_cooked_size != 0)
7943 size = section->_cooked_size;
7944 else
7945 size = section->_raw_size;
7946 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
7947 if (c == NULL)
7948 return FALSE;
7949 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
7950 }
7951
7952 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
7953 }
7954
7955 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
7956 count);
7957 }
7958
7959 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
7960 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
7961
7962 bfd_byte *
7963 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
7964 (bfd *abfd,
7965 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7966 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
7967 bfd_byte *data,
7968 bfd_boolean relocatable,
7969 asymbol **symbols)
7970 {
7971 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
7972 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
7973 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
7974
7975 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
7976 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
7977 long reloc_count;
7978
7979 if (reloc_size < 0)
7980 goto error_return;
7981
7982 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
7983 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
7984 goto error_return;
7985
7986 /* read in the section */
7987 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0,
7988 input_section->_raw_size))
7989 goto error_return;
7990
7991 /* We're not relaxing the section, so just copy the size info */
7992 input_section->_cooked_size = input_section->_raw_size;
7993 input_section->reloc_done = TRUE;
7994
7995 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
7996 input_section,
7997 reloc_vector,
7998 symbols);
7999 if (reloc_count < 0)
8000 goto error_return;
8001
8002 if (reloc_count > 0)
8003 {
8004 arelent **parent;
8005 /* for mips */
8006 int gp_found;
8007 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
8008
8009 {
8010 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
8011 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
8012 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
8013 if (abfd && input_bfd
8014 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
8015 lh = 0;
8016 else
8017 {
8018 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
8019 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
8020 }
8021 lookup:
8022 if (lh)
8023 {
8024 switch (lh->type)
8025 {
8026 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
8027 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
8028 case bfd_link_hash_common:
8029 gp_found = 0;
8030 break;
8031 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
8032 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
8033 gp_found = 1;
8034 gp = lh->u.def.value;
8035 break;
8036 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
8037 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
8038 lh = lh->u.i.link;
8039 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
8040 goto lookup;
8041 case bfd_link_hash_new:
8042 default:
8043 abort ();
8044 }
8045 }
8046 else
8047 gp_found = 0;
8048 }
8049 /* end mips */
8050 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
8051 {
8052 char *error_message = NULL;
8053 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
8054
8055 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
8056 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
8057 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
8058 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section) && abfd)
8059 {
8060 /* The special_function wouldn't get called anyway. */
8061 }
8062 else if (!gp_found)
8063 {
8064 /* The gp isn't there; let the special function code
8065 fall over on its own. */
8066 }
8067 else if ((*parent)->howto->special_function
8068 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
8069 {
8070 /* bypass special_function call */
8071 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
8072 input_section, relocatable,
8073 data, gp);
8074 goto skip_bfd_perform_relocation;
8075 }
8076 /* end mips specific stuff */
8077
8078 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data, input_section,
8079 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
8080 &error_message);
8081 skip_bfd_perform_relocation:
8082
8083 if (relocatable)
8084 {
8085 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
8086
8087 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
8088 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
8089 os->reloc_count++;
8090 }
8091
8092 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
8093 {
8094 switch (r)
8095 {
8096 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8097 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
8098 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8099 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address,
8100 TRUE)))
8101 goto error_return;
8102 break;
8103 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
8104 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
8105 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8106 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
8107 (*parent)->address)))
8108 goto error_return;
8109 break;
8110 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8111 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8112 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8113 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
8114 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
8115 goto error_return;
8116 break;
8117 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
8118 default:
8119 abort ();
8120 break;
8121 }
8122
8123 }
8124 }
8125 }
8126 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8127 free (reloc_vector);
8128 return data;
8129
8130 error_return:
8131 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8132 free (reloc_vector);
8133 return NULL;
8134 }
8135 \f
8136 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
8137
8138 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
8139 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
8140 {
8141 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
8142 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
8143
8144 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
8145 if (ret == NULL)
8146 return NULL;
8147
8148 if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
8149 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc))
8150 {
8151 free (ret);
8152 return NULL;
8153 }
8154
8155 #if 0
8156 /* We no longer use this. */
8157 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
8158 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
8159 #endif
8160 ret->procedure_count = 0;
8161 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
8162 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
8163 ret->rld_value = 0;
8164 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
8165
8166 return &ret->root.root;
8167 }
8168 \f
8169 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
8170 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
8171 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
8172
8173 bfd_boolean
8174 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8175 {
8176 asection **secpp;
8177 asection *o;
8178 struct bfd_link_order *p;
8179 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
8180 asection *rtproc_sec;
8181 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
8182 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
8183 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap
8184 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
8185 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
8186 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
8187 asection *s;
8188 EXTR esym;
8189 unsigned int i;
8190 bfd_size_type amt;
8191
8192 static const char * const secname[] =
8193 {
8194 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
8195 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
8196 };
8197 static const int sc[] =
8198 {
8199 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
8200 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
8201 };
8202
8203 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
8204 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
8205 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
8206 the sort again. */
8207 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8208 {
8209 bfd *dynobj;
8210 asection *got;
8211 struct mips_got_info *g;
8212
8213 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
8214 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
8215 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
8216 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
8217 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
8218 section above. */
8219 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, (info->shared
8220 ? bfd_count_sections (abfd) + 1
8221 : 1)))
8222 return FALSE;
8223
8224 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
8225 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8226 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8227 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
8228
8229 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
8230 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
8231 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8232 <= g->global_gotno);
8233 }
8234
8235 #if 0
8236 /* We want to set the GP value for ld -r. */
8237 /* On IRIX5, we omit the .options section. On IRIX6, however, we
8238 include it, even though we don't process it quite right. (Some
8239 entries are supposed to be merged.) Empirically, we seem to be
8240 better off including it then not. */
8241 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
8242 for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
8243 {
8244 if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
8245 {
8246 for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8247 if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
8248 p->u.indirect.section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8249 (*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL;
8250 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
8251 --abfd->section_count;
8252
8253 break;
8254 }
8255 }
8256
8257 /* We include .MIPS.options, even though we don't process it quite right.
8258 (Some entries are supposed to be merged.) At IRIX6 empirically we seem
8259 to be better off including it than not. */
8260 for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
8261 {
8262 if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, ".MIPS.options") == 0)
8263 {
8264 for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8265 if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
8266 p->u.indirect.section->flags &=~ SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8267 (*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL;
8268 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
8269 --abfd->section_count;
8270
8271 break;
8272 }
8273 }
8274 #endif
8275
8276 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
8277 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
8278 {
8279 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
8280
8281 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
8282 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
8283 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
8284 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
8285 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
8286 else if (info->relocatable)
8287 {
8288 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
8289
8290 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
8291 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8292 if (o->vma < lo
8293 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
8294 lo = o->vma;
8295
8296 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
8297 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (abfd);
8298 }
8299 else
8300 {
8301 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
8302 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
8303 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
8304 }
8305 }
8306
8307 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
8308 information. */
8309 reginfo_sec = NULL;
8310 mdebug_sec = NULL;
8311 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
8312 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
8313 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8314 {
8315 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
8316 {
8317 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
8318
8319 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
8320 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
8321 the information together. */
8322 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8323 {
8324 asection *input_section;
8325 bfd *input_bfd;
8326 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
8327 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
8328
8329 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
8330 {
8331 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
8332 continue;
8333 abort ();
8334 }
8335
8336 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
8337 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
8338
8339 /* The linker emulation code has probably clobbered the
8340 size to be zero bytes. */
8341 if (input_section->_raw_size == 0)
8342 input_section->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
8343
8344 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
8345 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
8346 return FALSE;
8347
8348 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
8349
8350 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
8351 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
8352 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
8353 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
8354 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
8355
8356 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
8357 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
8358 finally written out. */
8359
8360 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
8361 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
8362 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8363 }
8364
8365 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
8366 BFD_ASSERT(o->_raw_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
8367
8368 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
8369 matters, but someday it might). */
8370 o->link_order_head = NULL;
8371
8372 reginfo_sec = o;
8373 }
8374
8375 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
8376 {
8377 struct extsym_info einfo;
8378 bfd_vma last;
8379
8380 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
8381 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
8382 the information together. */
8383 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
8384 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
8385 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
8386 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
8387 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
8388 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
8389 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
8390 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
8391 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
8392 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
8393 symhdr->issMax = 0;
8394 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
8395 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
8396 symhdr->crfd = 0;
8397 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
8398
8399 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
8400 debug_info structure. */
8401 debug.line = NULL;
8402 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
8403 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
8404 debug.external_sym = NULL;
8405 debug.external_opt = NULL;
8406 debug.external_aux = NULL;
8407 debug.ss = NULL;
8408 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
8409 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
8410 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
8411 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
8412
8413 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
8414 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
8415 return FALSE;
8416
8417 esym.jmptbl = 0;
8418 esym.cobol_main = 0;
8419 esym.weakext = 0;
8420 esym.reserved = 0;
8421 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
8422 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
8423 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
8424 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
8425 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
8426 last = 0;
8427 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
8428 {
8429 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
8430 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
8431 if (s != NULL)
8432 {
8433 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
8434 last = s->vma + s->_raw_size;
8435 }
8436 else
8437 esym.asym.value = last;
8438 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
8439 secname[i], &esym))
8440 return FALSE;
8441 }
8442
8443 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8444 {
8445 asection *input_section;
8446 bfd *input_bfd;
8447 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
8448 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
8449 char *eraw_src;
8450 char *eraw_end;
8451
8452 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
8453 {
8454 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
8455 continue;
8456 abort ();
8457 }
8458
8459 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
8460 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
8461
8462 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8463 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
8464 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
8465 {
8466 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
8467 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
8468 want to deal with it. */
8469 continue;
8470 }
8471
8472 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
8473 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
8474
8475 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->_raw_size);
8476
8477 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
8478 read in the debugging information and set up an
8479 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
8480 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
8481 &input_debug))
8482 return FALSE;
8483
8484 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
8485 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
8486 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
8487 return FALSE;
8488
8489 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
8490 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
8491 the linker global hash table and save the information
8492 for the output external symbols. */
8493 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
8494 eraw_end = (eraw_src
8495 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
8496 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
8497 for (;
8498 eraw_src < eraw_end;
8499 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
8500 {
8501 EXTR ext;
8502 const char *name;
8503 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8504
8505 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
8506 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
8507 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
8508 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
8509 continue;
8510
8511 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
8512 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
8513 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
8514 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
8515 continue;
8516
8517 if (ext.ifd != -1)
8518 {
8519 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
8520 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
8521 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
8522 }
8523
8524 h->esym = ext;
8525 }
8526
8527 /* Free up the information we just read. */
8528 free (input_debug.line);
8529 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
8530 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
8531 free (input_debug.external_sym);
8532 free (input_debug.external_opt);
8533 free (input_debug.external_aux);
8534 free (input_debug.ss);
8535 free (input_debug.ssext);
8536 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
8537 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
8538 free (input_debug.external_ext);
8539
8540 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
8541 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
8542 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8543 }
8544
8545 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
8546 {
8547 /* Create .rtproc section. */
8548 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
8549 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
8550 {
8551 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
8552 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
8553
8554 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rtproc");
8555 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
8556 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, rtproc_sec, flags)
8557 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
8558 return FALSE;
8559 }
8560
8561 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
8562 info, rtproc_sec,
8563 &debug))
8564 return FALSE;
8565 }
8566
8567 /* Build the external symbol information. */
8568 einfo.abfd = abfd;
8569 einfo.info = info;
8570 einfo.debug = &debug;
8571 einfo.swap = swap;
8572 einfo.failed = FALSE;
8573 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
8574 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
8575 if (einfo.failed)
8576 return FALSE;
8577
8578 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
8579 o->_raw_size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
8580
8581 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
8582 matters, but someday it might). */
8583 o->link_order_head = NULL;
8584
8585 mdebug_sec = o;
8586 }
8587
8588 if (strncmp (o->name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
8589 {
8590 const char *subname;
8591 unsigned int c;
8592 Elf32_gptab *tab;
8593 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
8594 unsigned int j;
8595
8596 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
8597 information describing how the small data area would
8598 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
8599 not used in executables files. */
8600 if (! info->relocatable)
8601 {
8602 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8603 {
8604 asection *input_section;
8605
8606 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
8607 {
8608 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
8609 continue;
8610 abort ();
8611 }
8612
8613 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
8614
8615 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
8616 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
8617 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8618 }
8619
8620 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
8621 currently matters, but someday it might). */
8622 o->link_order_head = NULL;
8623
8624 /* Really remove the section. */
8625 for (secpp = &abfd->sections;
8626 *secpp != o;
8627 secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
8628 ;
8629 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
8630 --abfd->section_count;
8631
8632 continue;
8633 }
8634
8635 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
8636 uninitialized data. */
8637 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
8638 gptab_data_sec = o;
8639 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
8640 gptab_bss_sec = o;
8641 else
8642 {
8643 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8644 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
8645 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
8646 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
8647 return FALSE;
8648 }
8649
8650 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
8651 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
8652 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
8653 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
8654 case we must change the name of the output section. */
8655 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
8656 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
8657 {
8658 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
8659 o->name = ".gptab.data";
8660 else
8661 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
8662 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
8663 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
8664 }
8665
8666 /* Set up the first entry. */
8667 c = 1;
8668 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
8669 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
8670 if (tab == NULL)
8671 return FALSE;
8672 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
8673 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
8674
8675 /* Combine the input sections. */
8676 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8677 {
8678 asection *input_section;
8679 bfd *input_bfd;
8680 bfd_size_type size;
8681 unsigned long last;
8682 bfd_size_type gpentry;
8683
8684 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
8685 {
8686 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
8687 continue;
8688 abort ();
8689 }
8690
8691 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
8692 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
8693
8694 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
8695 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
8696 sorted by ascending -G value. */
8697 size = bfd_section_size (input_bfd, input_section);
8698 last = 0;
8699 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
8700 gpentry < size;
8701 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
8702 {
8703 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
8704 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
8705 unsigned long val;
8706 unsigned long add;
8707 bfd_boolean exact;
8708 unsigned int look;
8709
8710 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
8711 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
8712 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
8713 {
8714 free (tab);
8715 return FALSE;
8716 }
8717
8718 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
8719 &int_gptab);
8720 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
8721 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
8722
8723 exact = FALSE;
8724 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
8725 {
8726 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
8727 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
8728
8729 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
8730 exact = TRUE;
8731 }
8732
8733 if (! exact)
8734 {
8735 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
8736 unsigned int max;
8737
8738 /* We need a new table entry. */
8739 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
8740 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
8741 if (new_tab == NULL)
8742 {
8743 free (tab);
8744 return FALSE;
8745 }
8746 tab = new_tab;
8747 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
8748 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
8749
8750 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
8751 value, since that will be implied by this new
8752 value. */
8753 max = 0;
8754 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
8755 {
8756 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
8757 && (max == 0
8758 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
8759 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
8760 max = look;
8761 }
8762 if (max != 0)
8763 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
8764 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
8765
8766 ++c;
8767 }
8768
8769 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
8770 }
8771
8772 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
8773 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
8774 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8775 }
8776
8777 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
8778 if (c > 2)
8779 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
8780
8781 /* Swap out the table. */
8782 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
8783 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8784 if (ext_tab == NULL)
8785 {
8786 free (tab);
8787 return FALSE;
8788 }
8789
8790 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
8791 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
8792 free (tab);
8793
8794 o->_raw_size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
8795 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
8796
8797 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
8798 matters, but someday it might). */
8799 o->link_order_head = NULL;
8800 }
8801 }
8802
8803 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
8804 if (!MNAME(abfd,bfd_elf,bfd_final_link) (abfd, info))
8805 return FALSE;
8806
8807 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
8808
8809 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
8810 {
8811 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
8812
8813 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
8814 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
8815 return FALSE;
8816 }
8817
8818 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
8819 {
8820 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
8821 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
8822 swap, info,
8823 mdebug_sec->filepos))
8824 return FALSE;
8825
8826 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
8827 }
8828
8829 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
8830 {
8831 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
8832 gptab_data_sec->contents,
8833 0, gptab_data_sec->_raw_size))
8834 return FALSE;
8835 }
8836
8837 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
8838 {
8839 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
8840 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
8841 0, gptab_bss_sec->_raw_size))
8842 return FALSE;
8843 }
8844
8845 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8846 {
8847 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
8848 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
8849 {
8850 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
8851 rtproc_sec->contents,
8852 0, rtproc_sec->_raw_size))
8853 return FALSE;
8854 }
8855 }
8856
8857 return TRUE;
8858 }
8859 \f
8860 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
8861
8862 struct mips_mach_extension {
8863 unsigned long extension, base;
8864 };
8865
8866
8867 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
8868 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
8869
8870 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
8871 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
8872 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
8873 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
8874
8875 /* MIPS V extensions. */
8876 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
8877
8878 /* R10000 extensions. */
8879 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
8880
8881 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
8882 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
8883 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
8884 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
8885 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
8886 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
8887 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
8888
8889 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
8890 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
8891 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
8892 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
8893 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
8894
8895 /* VR4100 extensions. */
8896 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
8897 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
8898
8899 /* MIPS III extensions. */
8900 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8901 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8902 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8903 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8904 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8905 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8906 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
8907
8908 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
8909 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
8910
8911 /* MIPS II extensions. */
8912 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
8913 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
8914
8915 /* MIPS I extensions. */
8916 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
8917 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
8918 };
8919
8920
8921 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
8922
8923 static bfd_boolean
8924 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
8925 {
8926 size_t i;
8927
8928 for (i = 0; extension != base && i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
8929 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
8930 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
8931
8932 return extension == base;
8933 }
8934
8935
8936 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
8937
8938 static bfd_boolean
8939 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
8940 {
8941 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
8942 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
8943 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
8944 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
8945 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
8946 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
8947 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
8948 }
8949
8950
8951 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
8952 object file when linking. */
8953
8954 bfd_boolean
8955 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
8956 {
8957 flagword old_flags;
8958 flagword new_flags;
8959 bfd_boolean ok;
8960 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
8961 asection *sec;
8962
8963 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
8964 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
8965 {
8966 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8967 (_("%s: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
8968 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
8969 return FALSE;
8970 }
8971
8972 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8973 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8974 return TRUE;
8975
8976 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
8977 {
8978 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8979 (_("%s: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
8980 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
8981 return FALSE;
8982 }
8983
8984 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
8985 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
8986 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
8987
8988 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
8989 {
8990 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
8991 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
8992 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
8993 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
8994
8995 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
8996 && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
8997 {
8998 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
8999 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9000 return FALSE;
9001 }
9002
9003 return TRUE;
9004 }
9005
9006 /* Check flag compatibility. */
9007
9008 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9009 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9010
9011 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
9012 doesn't seem to matter. */
9013 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9014 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9015
9016 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
9017 just be able to ignore this. */
9018 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9019 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9020
9021 if (new_flags == old_flags)
9022 return TRUE;
9023
9024 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
9025 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
9026 actually cause any incompatibility. */
9027 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9028 {
9029 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
9030 which are automatically generated by gas. */
9031 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
9032 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
9033 && ((!strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
9034 || !strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
9035 || !strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))
9036 && sec->_raw_size != 0))
9037 {
9038 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
9039 break;
9040 }
9041 }
9042 if (null_input_bfd)
9043 return TRUE;
9044
9045 ok = TRUE;
9046
9047 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
9048 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
9049 {
9050 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9051 (_("%s: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
9052 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
9053 ok = TRUE;
9054 }
9055
9056 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
9057 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
9058 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
9059 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
9060
9061 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9062 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9063
9064 /* Compare the ISAs. */
9065 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
9066 {
9067 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9068 (_("%s: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
9069 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
9070 ok = FALSE;
9071 }
9072 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
9073 {
9074 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
9075 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9076 {
9077 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
9078 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
9079 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
9080 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
9081 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9082 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
9083 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9084
9085 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
9086 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
9087 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
9088 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
9089 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
9090 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
9091 }
9092 else
9093 {
9094 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
9095 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9096 (_("%s: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9097 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd),
9098 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
9099 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
9100 ok = FALSE;
9101 }
9102 }
9103
9104 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9105 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9106
9107 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
9108 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
9109 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
9110 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9111 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9112 {
9113 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
9114 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9115 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9116 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9117 {
9118 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9119 (_("%s: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9120 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd),
9121 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
9122 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
9123 ok = FALSE;
9124 }
9125 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9126 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9127 }
9128
9129 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
9130 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
9131 {
9132 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9133
9134 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9135 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9136 }
9137
9138 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
9139 if (new_flags != old_flags)
9140 {
9141 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9142 (_("%s: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
9143 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd), (unsigned long) new_flags,
9144 (unsigned long) old_flags);
9145 ok = FALSE;
9146 }
9147
9148 if (! ok)
9149 {
9150 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9151 return FALSE;
9152 }
9153
9154 return TRUE;
9155 }
9156
9157 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
9158
9159 bfd_boolean
9160 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
9161 {
9162 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
9163 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
9164
9165 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
9166 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
9167 return TRUE;
9168 }
9169
9170 bfd_boolean
9171 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
9172 {
9173 FILE *file = ptr;
9174
9175 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
9176
9177 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
9178 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
9179
9180 /* xgettext:c-format */
9181 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
9182
9183 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
9184 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
9185 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
9186 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
9187 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
9188 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
9189 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
9190 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
9191 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9192 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
9193 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
9194 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
9195 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
9196 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
9197 else
9198 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
9199
9200 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
9201 fprintf (file, _(" [mips1]"));
9202 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
9203 fprintf (file, _(" [mips2]"));
9204 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
9205 fprintf (file, _(" [mips3]"));
9206 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
9207 fprintf (file, _(" [mips4]"));
9208 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
9209 fprintf (file, _(" [mips5]"));
9210 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
9211 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32]"));
9212 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
9213 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64]"));
9214 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
9215 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32r2]"));
9216 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
9217 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64r2]"));
9218 else
9219 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
9220
9221 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
9222 fprintf (file, _(" [mdmx]"));
9223
9224 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
9225 fprintf (file, _(" [mips16]"));
9226
9227 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
9228 fprintf (file, _(" [32bitmode]"));
9229 else
9230 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
9231
9232 fputc ('\n', file);
9233
9234 return TRUE;
9235 }
9236
9237 struct bfd_elf_special_section const _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[]=
9238 {
9239 { ".sdata", 6, -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9240 { ".sbss", 5, -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9241 { ".lit4", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9242 { ".lit8", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
9243 { ".ucode", 6, 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
9244 { ".mdebug", 7, 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
9245 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
9246 };
This page took 0.249266 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.